1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/ethtool.h> 14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> 15 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 16 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 17 #include <linux/list.h> 18 #include <linux/bug.h> 19 #include <linux/netlink.h> 20 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 21 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 22 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 24 #include <linux/net.h> 25 #include <linux/rfkill.h> 26 #include <net/regulatory.h> 27 28 /** 29 * DOC: Introduction 30 * 31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 37 * 38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 39 * use restrictions. 40 */ 41 42 43 /** 44 * DOC: Device registration 45 * 46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 48 * described below. 49 * 50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 55 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 59 * 60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 63 */ 64 65 struct wiphy; 66 67 /* 68 * wireless hardware capability structures 69 */ 70 71 /** 72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 73 * 74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 75 * 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 78 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 80 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 81 * is not permitted. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 83 * is not permitted. 84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 85 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 86 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 87 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 88 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 89 * restrictions. 90 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 91 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 92 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 93 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 94 * restrictions. 95 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 98 * on this channel. 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 102 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 103 * on this channel. 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 105 * on this channel. 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 107 * on this channel. 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 109 * on this channel. 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 111 * on this channel. 112 * 113 */ 114 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 115 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 116 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 117 /* hole at 1<<2 */ 118 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 119 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 120 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 121 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 131 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 132 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 133 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 134 }; 135 136 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 137 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 138 139 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 140 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 141 142 /** 143 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 144 * 145 * This structure describes a single channel for use 146 * with cfg80211. 147 * 148 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 149 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 150 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 151 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 152 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 153 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 154 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 155 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 156 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 157 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 158 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 159 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 160 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 161 * @orig_mag: internal use 162 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 163 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 164 * on this channel. 165 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 166 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 167 */ 168 struct ieee80211_channel { 169 enum nl80211_band band; 170 u32 center_freq; 171 u16 freq_offset; 172 u16 hw_value; 173 u32 flags; 174 int max_antenna_gain; 175 int max_power; 176 int max_reg_power; 177 bool beacon_found; 178 u32 orig_flags; 179 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 180 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 181 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 182 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 183 }; 184 185 /** 186 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 187 * 188 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 189 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 190 * different bands/PHY modes. 191 * 192 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 193 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 194 * with CCK rates. 195 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 196 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 197 * core code when registering the wiphy. 198 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 199 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 200 * core code when registering the wiphy. 201 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 202 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 203 * core code when registering the wiphy. 204 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 205 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 206 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 207 */ 208 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 209 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 210 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 211 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 212 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 213 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 214 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 215 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 216 }; 217 218 /** 219 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 220 * 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 223 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 224 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 225 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 226 */ 227 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 228 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 229 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 230 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 231 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 232 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 233 }; 234 235 /** 236 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 237 * 238 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 239 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 240 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 241 */ 242 enum ieee80211_privacy { 243 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 244 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 245 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 246 }; 247 248 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 249 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 250 251 /** 252 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 253 * 254 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 255 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 256 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 257 * passed around. 258 * 259 * @flags: rate-specific flags 260 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 261 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 262 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 263 * short preamble is used 264 */ 265 struct ieee80211_rate { 266 u32 flags; 267 u16 bitrate; 268 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 269 }; 270 271 /** 272 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 273 * 274 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 275 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 276 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 277 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 278 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 279 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 280 * members of the SRG 281 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 282 * used by members of the SRG 283 */ 284 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 285 bool enable; 286 u8 sr_ctrl; 287 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 288 u8 min_offset; 289 u8 max_offset; 290 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 291 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 292 }; 293 294 /** 295 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 296 * 297 * @color: the current color. 298 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 299 * @partial: define the AID equation. 300 */ 301 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 302 u8 color; 303 bool enabled; 304 bool partial; 305 }; 306 307 /** 308 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 309 * 310 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 311 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 312 * 313 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 314 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 315 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 316 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 317 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 318 */ 319 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 320 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 321 bool ht_supported; 322 u8 ampdu_factor; 323 u8 ampdu_density; 324 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 325 }; 326 327 /** 328 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 329 * 330 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 331 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 332 * 333 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 334 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 335 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 336 */ 337 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 338 bool vht_supported; 339 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 340 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 341 }; 342 343 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 344 345 /** 346 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 347 * 348 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 349 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 350 * 351 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 352 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 353 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 354 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 355 */ 356 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 357 bool has_he; 358 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 359 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 360 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 361 }; 362 363 /** 364 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type 365 * 366 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 367 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 368 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 369 * 370 * @types_mask: interface types mask 371 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 372 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 373 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 374 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise 375 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data 376 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length 377 */ 378 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 379 u16 types_mask; 380 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 381 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 382 struct { 383 const u8 *data; 384 unsigned int len; 385 } vendor_elems; 386 }; 387 388 /** 389 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 390 * 391 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 392 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 393 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 394 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 395 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 396 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 397 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 398 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 399 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 400 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 401 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 402 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 403 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 404 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 405 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 406 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 407 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 408 */ 409 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 410 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 411 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 412 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 413 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 414 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 415 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 416 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 417 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 418 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 419 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 420 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 421 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 426 * 427 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 428 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 429 * 430 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 431 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 432 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 433 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 434 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 435 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 436 */ 437 struct ieee80211_edmg { 438 u8 channels; 439 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 440 }; 441 442 /** 443 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 444 * 445 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 446 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 447 * 448 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA 449 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 450 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 451 */ 452 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 453 bool s1g; 454 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 455 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 456 }; 457 458 /** 459 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 460 * 461 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 462 * is able to operate in. 463 * 464 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 465 * in this band. 466 * @band: the band this structure represents 467 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 468 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 469 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 470 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 471 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 472 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 473 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 474 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 475 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 476 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 477 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 478 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 479 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 480 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 481 * iftype_data). 482 */ 483 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 484 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 485 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 486 enum nl80211_band band; 487 int n_channels; 488 int n_bitrates; 489 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 490 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 491 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 492 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 493 u16 n_iftype_data; 494 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; 495 }; 496 497 /** 498 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 499 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 500 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 501 * 502 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 503 */ 504 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 505 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 506 u8 iftype) 507 { 508 int i; 509 510 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 511 return NULL; 512 513 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) { 514 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 515 &sband->iftype_data[i]; 516 517 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 518 return data; 519 } 520 521 return NULL; 522 } 523 524 /** 525 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 526 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 527 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 528 * 529 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 530 */ 531 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 532 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 533 u8 iftype) 534 { 535 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 536 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 537 538 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 539 return &data->he_cap; 540 541 return NULL; 542 } 543 544 /** 545 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 546 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 547 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 548 * 549 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 550 */ 551 static inline __le16 552 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 553 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 554 { 555 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 556 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 557 558 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 559 return 0; 560 561 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 562 } 563 564 /** 565 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 566 * 567 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 568 * 569 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 570 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 571 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 572 * 573 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 574 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 575 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 576 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 577 * without affecting other devices. 578 * 579 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 580 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 581 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 582 */ 583 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 584 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 585 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 586 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 587 { 588 } 589 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 590 591 592 /* 593 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 594 */ 595 596 /** 597 * DOC: Actions and configuration 598 * 599 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 600 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 601 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 602 * operations use are described separately. 603 * 604 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 605 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 606 * 607 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 608 * in a separate chapter. 609 */ 610 611 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 612 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 613 614 /** 615 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 616 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 617 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 618 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 619 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 620 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 621 * determine the address as needed. 622 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 623 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 624 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 625 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 626 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 627 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 628 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 629 */ 630 struct vif_params { 631 u32 flags; 632 int use_4addr; 633 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 634 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 635 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 636 }; 637 638 /** 639 * struct key_params - key information 640 * 641 * Information about a key 642 * 643 * @key: key material 644 * @key_len: length of key material 645 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 646 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 647 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 648 * length given by @seq_len. 649 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 650 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 651 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 652 */ 653 struct key_params { 654 const u8 *key; 655 const u8 *seq; 656 int key_len; 657 int seq_len; 658 u16 vlan_id; 659 u32 cipher; 660 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 661 }; 662 663 /** 664 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 665 * @chan: the (control) channel 666 * @width: channel width 667 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 668 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 669 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 670 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 671 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 672 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 673 * parameters are ignored. 674 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 675 */ 676 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 677 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 678 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 679 u32 center_freq1; 680 u32 center_freq2; 681 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 682 u16 freq1_offset; 683 }; 684 685 /* 686 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 687 */ 688 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 689 struct { 690 u32 legacy; 691 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 692 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 693 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 694 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 695 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 696 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 697 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 698 }; 699 700 701 /** 702 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 703 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 704 * of the peer. 705 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 706 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 707 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 708 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 709 * @retry_long: retry count value 710 * @retry_short: retry count value 711 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 712 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 713 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 714 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 715 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 716 */ 717 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 718 bool config_override; 719 u8 tids; 720 u64 mask; 721 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 722 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 723 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 724 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 725 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 726 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 727 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 728 }; 729 730 /** 731 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 732 * @peer: Station's MAC address 733 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 734 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 735 */ 736 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 737 const u8 *peer; 738 u32 n_tid_conf; 739 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[]; 740 }; 741 742 /** 743 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 744 * @chandef: the channel definition 745 * 746 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 747 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 748 */ 749 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 750 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 751 { 752 switch (chandef->width) { 753 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 754 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 755 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 756 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 757 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 758 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 759 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 760 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 761 default: 762 WARN_ON(1); 763 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 764 } 765 } 766 767 /** 768 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 769 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 770 * @channel: the control channel 771 * @chantype: the channel type 772 * 773 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 774 */ 775 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 776 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 777 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 778 779 /** 780 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 781 * @chandef1: first channel definition 782 * @chandef2: second channel definition 783 * 784 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 785 * identical, %false otherwise. 786 */ 787 static inline bool 788 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 789 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 790 { 791 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 792 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 793 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 794 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 795 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 796 } 797 798 /** 799 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 800 * 801 * @chandef: the channel definition 802 * 803 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 804 */ 805 static inline bool 806 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 807 { 808 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 809 } 810 811 /** 812 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 813 * @chandef1: first channel definition 814 * @chandef2: second channel definition 815 * 816 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 817 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 818 */ 819 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 820 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 821 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 822 823 /** 824 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 825 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 826 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 827 */ 828 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 829 830 /** 831 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 832 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 833 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 834 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 835 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 836 */ 837 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 838 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 839 u32 prohibited_flags); 840 841 /** 842 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 843 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 844 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 845 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 846 * Returns: 847 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 848 */ 849 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 850 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 851 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 852 853 /** 854 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 855 * 856 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 857 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 858 * 859 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 860 * 861 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 862 */ 863 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 864 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 865 { 866 switch (chandef->width) { 867 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 868 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 869 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 870 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 871 default: 872 break; 873 } 874 return 0; 875 } 876 877 /** 878 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 879 * 880 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 881 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 882 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 883 * 884 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 885 * 886 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 887 */ 888 static inline int 889 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 890 { 891 switch (chandef->width) { 892 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 893 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 894 chandef->chan->max_power); 895 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 896 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 897 chandef->chan->max_power); 898 default: 899 break; 900 } 901 return chandef->chan->max_power; 902 } 903 904 /** 905 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels 906 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for 907 * @band_mask: which bands to check on 908 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, 909 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account 910 */ 911 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, 912 unsigned long band_mask, 913 u32 prohibited_flags); 914 915 /** 916 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 917 * 918 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 919 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 920 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 921 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 922 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 923 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 924 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 925 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 926 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 927 * 928 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 929 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 930 */ 931 enum survey_info_flags { 932 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 933 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 934 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 935 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 936 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 937 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 938 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 939 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 940 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 941 }; 942 943 /** 944 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 945 * 946 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 947 * record to report global statistics 948 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 949 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 950 * optional 951 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 952 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 953 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 954 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 955 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 956 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 957 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 958 * 959 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 960 * 961 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 962 * channel duty cycle etc. 963 */ 964 struct survey_info { 965 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 966 u64 time; 967 u64 time_busy; 968 u64 time_ext_busy; 969 u64 time_rx; 970 u64 time_tx; 971 u64 time_scan; 972 u64 time_bss_rx; 973 u32 filled; 974 s8 noise; 975 }; 976 977 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4 978 979 /** 980 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 981 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 982 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 983 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 984 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 985 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 986 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 987 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 988 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 989 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 990 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 991 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 992 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 993 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 994 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 995 * protocol frames. 996 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 997 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 998 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 999 * port for mac80211 1000 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 1001 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 1002 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 1003 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1004 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1005 * offload) 1006 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1007 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: 1008 * 1009 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED 1010 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any 1011 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in 1012 * such a scenario. 1013 * 1014 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK 1015 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only 1016 * 1017 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT 1018 * Allow hash-to-element only 1019 * 1020 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH 1021 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element 1022 */ 1023 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1024 u32 wpa_versions; 1025 u32 cipher_group; 1026 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1027 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1028 int n_akm_suites; 1029 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES]; 1030 bool control_port; 1031 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1032 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1033 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1034 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1035 struct key_params *wep_keys; 1036 int wep_tx_key; 1037 const u8 *psk; 1038 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1039 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1040 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; 1041 }; 1042 1043 /** 1044 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1045 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1046 * or %NULL if not changed 1047 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1048 * or %NULL if not changed 1049 * @head_len: length of @head 1050 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1051 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1052 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1053 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1054 * frames or %NULL 1055 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1056 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1057 * Response frames or %NULL 1058 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1059 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1060 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1061 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1062 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1063 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1064 * (measurement type 8) 1065 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1066 * Token (measurement type 11) 1067 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1068 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1069 */ 1070 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1071 const u8 *head, *tail; 1072 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1073 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1074 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1075 const u8 *probe_resp; 1076 const u8 *lci; 1077 const u8 *civicloc; 1078 s8 ftm_responder; 1079 1080 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1081 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1082 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1083 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1084 size_t probe_resp_len; 1085 size_t lci_len; 1086 size_t civicloc_len; 1087 }; 1088 1089 struct mac_address { 1090 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1091 }; 1092 1093 /** 1094 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1095 * 1096 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1097 * entry specified by mac_addr 1098 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1099 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1100 */ 1101 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1102 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1103 int n_acl_entries; 1104 1105 /* Keep it last */ 1106 struct mac_address mac_addrs[]; 1107 }; 1108 1109 /** 1110 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1111 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1112 * 1113 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1114 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1115 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1116 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1117 * frame headers. 1118 */ 1119 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1120 u32 min_interval; 1121 u32 max_interval; 1122 size_t tmpl_len; 1123 const u8 *tmpl; 1124 }; 1125 1126 /** 1127 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1128 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1129 * 1130 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1131 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1132 * scanning 1133 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1134 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1135 */ 1136 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1137 u32 interval; 1138 size_t tmpl_len; 1139 const u8 *tmpl; 1140 }; 1141 1142 /** 1143 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 1144 * 1145 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings 1146 * 1147 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication 1148 */ 1149 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags { 1150 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0), 1151 }; 1152 1153 /** 1154 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1155 * 1156 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1157 * 1158 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1159 * @beacon: beacon data 1160 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1161 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1162 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1163 * user space) 1164 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1165 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1166 * @crypto: crypto settings 1167 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1168 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1169 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1170 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1171 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1172 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1173 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1174 * MAC address based access control 1175 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1176 * networks. 1177 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1178 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1179 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1180 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1181 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1182 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1183 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1184 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1185 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE 1186 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags 1187 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1188 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1189 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1190 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1191 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1192 */ 1193 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1194 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1195 1196 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1197 1198 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1199 const u8 *ssid; 1200 size_t ssid_len; 1201 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1202 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1203 bool privacy; 1204 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1205 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1206 int inactivity_timeout; 1207 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1208 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1209 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1210 bool pbss; 1211 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1212 1213 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1214 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1215 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1216 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1217 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; 1218 bool twt_responder; 1219 u32 flags; 1220 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1221 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1222 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1223 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1224 }; 1225 1226 /** 1227 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1228 * 1229 * Used for channel switch 1230 * 1231 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1232 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1233 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1234 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1235 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1236 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1237 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1238 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1239 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1240 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1241 */ 1242 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1243 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1244 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1245 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1246 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1247 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1248 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1249 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1250 bool radar_required; 1251 bool block_tx; 1252 u8 count; 1253 }; 1254 1255 /** 1256 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings 1257 * 1258 * Used for bss color change 1259 * 1260 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown 1261 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1262 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1263 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change 1264 * @count: number of beacons until the color change 1265 * @color: the color used after the change 1266 */ 1267 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings { 1268 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change; 1269 u16 counter_offset_beacon; 1270 u16 counter_offset_presp; 1271 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next; 1272 u8 count; 1273 u8 color; 1274 }; 1275 1276 /** 1277 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1278 * 1279 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1280 * 1281 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1282 * to use for verification 1283 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1284 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1285 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1286 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1287 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1288 * nl80211_iftype. 1289 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1290 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1291 * the verification 1292 */ 1293 struct iface_combination_params { 1294 int num_different_channels; 1295 u8 radar_detect; 1296 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1297 u32 new_beacon_int; 1298 }; 1299 1300 /** 1301 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1302 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1303 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1304 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1305 * 1306 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1307 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1308 */ 1309 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1310 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1311 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1312 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1313 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3), 1314 }; 1315 1316 /** 1317 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1318 * 1319 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1320 * 1321 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1322 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1323 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1324 * power per-interface or per-station. 1325 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1326 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1327 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1328 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1329 * per peer TPC. 1330 */ 1331 struct sta_txpwr { 1332 s16 power; 1333 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1334 }; 1335 1336 /** 1337 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1338 * 1339 * Used to change and create a new station. 1340 * 1341 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1342 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1343 * (or NULL for no change) 1344 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1345 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1346 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1347 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1348 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1349 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1350 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1351 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1352 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1353 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1354 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1355 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1356 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1357 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1358 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1359 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1360 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1361 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1362 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1363 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1364 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1365 * to unknown) 1366 * @capability: station capability 1367 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1368 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1369 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1370 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1371 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1372 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1373 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1374 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1375 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1376 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1377 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1378 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1379 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1380 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1381 */ 1382 struct station_parameters { 1383 const u8 *supported_rates; 1384 struct net_device *vlan; 1385 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1386 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1387 int listen_interval; 1388 u16 aid; 1389 u16 vlan_id; 1390 u16 peer_aid; 1391 u8 supported_rates_len; 1392 u8 plink_action; 1393 u8 plink_state; 1394 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1395 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1396 u8 uapsd_queues; 1397 u8 max_sp; 1398 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1399 u16 capability; 1400 const u8 *ext_capab; 1401 u8 ext_capab_len; 1402 const u8 *supported_channels; 1403 u8 supported_channels_len; 1404 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1405 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1406 u8 opmode_notif; 1407 bool opmode_notif_used; 1408 int support_p2p_ps; 1409 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1410 u8 he_capa_len; 1411 u16 airtime_weight; 1412 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1413 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1414 }; 1415 1416 /** 1417 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1418 * 1419 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1420 * 1421 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1422 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1423 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1424 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1425 */ 1426 struct station_del_parameters { 1427 const u8 *mac; 1428 u8 subtype; 1429 u16 reason_code; 1430 }; 1431 1432 /** 1433 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1434 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1435 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1436 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1437 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1438 * the AP MLME in the device 1439 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1440 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1441 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1442 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1443 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1444 * supported/used) 1445 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1446 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1447 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1448 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1449 */ 1450 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1451 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1452 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1453 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1454 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1455 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1456 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1457 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1458 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1459 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1460 }; 1461 1462 /** 1463 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1464 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1465 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1466 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1467 * 1468 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1469 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1470 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1471 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1472 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1473 */ 1474 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1475 struct station_parameters *params, 1476 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1477 1478 /** 1479 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1480 * 1481 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1482 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1483 * 1484 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1485 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1486 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1487 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1488 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1489 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1490 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS 1491 */ 1492 enum rate_info_flags { 1493 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1494 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1495 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1496 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1497 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1498 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1499 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), 1500 }; 1501 1502 /** 1503 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1504 * 1505 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1506 * 1507 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1508 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1509 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1510 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1511 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1512 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1513 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1514 */ 1515 enum rate_info_bw { 1516 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1517 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1518 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1519 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1520 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1521 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1522 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1523 }; 1524 1525 /** 1526 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1527 * 1528 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1529 * 1530 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1531 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate 1532 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1533 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1534 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1535 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1536 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1537 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1538 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1539 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1540 */ 1541 struct rate_info { 1542 u8 flags; 1543 u8 mcs; 1544 u16 legacy; 1545 u8 nss; 1546 u8 bw; 1547 u8 he_gi; 1548 u8 he_dcm; 1549 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1550 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1551 }; 1552 1553 /** 1554 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1555 * 1556 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1557 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1558 * 1559 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1560 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1561 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1562 */ 1563 enum bss_param_flags { 1564 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1565 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1566 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1567 }; 1568 1569 /** 1570 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1571 * 1572 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1573 * 1574 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1575 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1576 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1577 */ 1578 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1579 u8 flags; 1580 u8 dtim_period; 1581 u16 beacon_interval; 1582 }; 1583 1584 /** 1585 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1586 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1587 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1588 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1589 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1590 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1591 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1592 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1593 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1594 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1595 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1596 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1597 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1598 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1599 */ 1600 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1601 u32 filled; 1602 u32 backlog_bytes; 1603 u32 backlog_packets; 1604 u32 flows; 1605 u32 drops; 1606 u32 ecn_marks; 1607 u32 overlimit; 1608 u32 overmemory; 1609 u32 collisions; 1610 u32 tx_bytes; 1611 u32 tx_packets; 1612 u32 max_flows; 1613 }; 1614 1615 /** 1616 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1617 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1618 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1619 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1620 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1621 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1622 * transmitted MSDUs 1623 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1624 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1625 */ 1626 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1627 u32 filled; 1628 u64 rx_msdu; 1629 u64 tx_msdu; 1630 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1631 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1632 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1633 }; 1634 1635 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1636 1637 /** 1638 * struct station_info - station information 1639 * 1640 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1641 * 1642 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1643 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1644 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1645 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1646 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1647 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1648 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1649 * @llid: mesh local link id 1650 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1651 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1652 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1653 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1654 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1655 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1656 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1657 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1658 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1659 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1660 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1661 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1662 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1663 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1664 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 1665 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 1666 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 1667 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1668 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 1669 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1670 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1671 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 1672 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 1673 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 1674 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 1675 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 1676 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 1677 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 1678 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 1679 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 1680 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 1681 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 1682 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 1683 * towards this station. 1684 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 1685 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 1686 * from this peer 1687 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 1688 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 1689 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 1690 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 1691 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 1692 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 1693 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 1694 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 1695 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 1696 * been sent. 1697 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 1698 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 1699 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 1700 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 1701 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 1702 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 1703 */ 1704 struct station_info { 1705 u64 filled; 1706 u32 connected_time; 1707 u32 inactive_time; 1708 u64 assoc_at; 1709 u64 rx_bytes; 1710 u64 tx_bytes; 1711 u16 llid; 1712 u16 plid; 1713 u8 plink_state; 1714 s8 signal; 1715 s8 signal_avg; 1716 1717 u8 chains; 1718 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1719 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1720 1721 struct rate_info txrate; 1722 struct rate_info rxrate; 1723 u32 rx_packets; 1724 u32 tx_packets; 1725 u32 tx_retries; 1726 u32 tx_failed; 1727 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 1728 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 1729 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 1730 1731 int generation; 1732 1733 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 1734 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 1735 1736 u32 beacon_loss_count; 1737 s64 t_offset; 1738 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1739 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 1740 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 1741 1742 u32 expected_throughput; 1743 1744 u64 tx_duration; 1745 u64 rx_duration; 1746 u64 rx_beacon; 1747 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 1748 u8 connected_to_gate; 1749 1750 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 1751 s8 ack_signal; 1752 s8 avg_ack_signal; 1753 1754 u16 airtime_weight; 1755 1756 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 1757 u32 fcs_err_count; 1758 1759 u32 airtime_link_metric; 1760 1761 u8 connected_to_as; 1762 }; 1763 1764 /** 1765 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit 1766 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm 1767 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to 1768 */ 1769 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { 1770 s32 power; 1771 u32 freq_range_index; 1772 }; 1773 1774 /** 1775 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs 1776 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types 1777 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs 1778 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs 1779 */ 1780 struct cfg80211_sar_specs { 1781 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 1782 u32 num_sub_specs; 1783 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; 1784 }; 1785 1786 1787 /** 1788 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges 1789 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency 1790 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency 1791 */ 1792 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { 1793 u32 start_freq; 1794 u32 end_freq; 1795 }; 1796 1797 /** 1798 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability 1799 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types 1800 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges 1801 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. 1802 * 1803 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing 1804 * range to small ones and then append them. 1805 */ 1806 struct cfg80211_sar_capa { 1807 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 1808 u32 num_freq_ranges; 1809 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; 1810 }; 1811 1812 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 1813 /** 1814 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 1815 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 1816 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 1817 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 1818 * 1819 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 1820 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 1821 * considered undefined. 1822 */ 1823 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 1824 struct station_info *sinfo); 1825 #else 1826 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 1827 const u8 *mac_addr, 1828 struct station_info *sinfo) 1829 { 1830 return -ENOENT; 1831 } 1832 #endif 1833 1834 /** 1835 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 1836 * 1837 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 1838 * according to the nl80211 flags. 1839 * 1840 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 1841 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 1842 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 1843 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 1844 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 1845 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 1846 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 1847 */ 1848 enum monitor_flags { 1849 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 1850 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 1851 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 1852 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 1853 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 1854 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 1855 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 1856 }; 1857 1858 /** 1859 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 1860 * 1861 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 1862 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 1863 * 1864 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 1865 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 1866 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 1867 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 1868 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 1869 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 1870 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 1871 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 1872 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 1873 */ 1874 enum mpath_info_flags { 1875 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 1876 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 1877 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 1878 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 1879 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 1880 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 1881 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 1882 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 1883 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 1884 }; 1885 1886 /** 1887 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 1888 * 1889 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 1890 * 1891 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 1892 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 1893 * @sn: target sequence number 1894 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 1895 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 1896 * @flags: mesh path flags 1897 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 1898 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 1899 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1900 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 1901 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1902 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1903 * @hop_count: hops to destination 1904 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 1905 */ 1906 struct mpath_info { 1907 u32 filled; 1908 u32 frame_qlen; 1909 u32 sn; 1910 u32 metric; 1911 u32 exptime; 1912 u32 discovery_timeout; 1913 u8 discovery_retries; 1914 u8 flags; 1915 u8 hop_count; 1916 u32 path_change_count; 1917 1918 int generation; 1919 }; 1920 1921 /** 1922 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 1923 * 1924 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 1925 * 1926 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 1927 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1928 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 1929 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1930 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 1931 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1932 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1933 * (or NULL for no change) 1934 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 1935 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 1936 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1937 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 1938 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 1939 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 1940 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 1941 */ 1942 struct bss_parameters { 1943 int use_cts_prot; 1944 int use_short_preamble; 1945 int use_short_slot_time; 1946 const u8 *basic_rates; 1947 u8 basic_rates_len; 1948 int ap_isolate; 1949 int ht_opmode; 1950 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 1951 }; 1952 1953 /** 1954 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 1955 * 1956 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 1957 * 1958 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 1959 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 1960 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 1961 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 1962 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 1963 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 1964 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 1965 * mesh interface 1966 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 1967 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 1968 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 1969 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 1970 * elements 1971 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 1972 * detect compatible mesh peers 1973 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 1974 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 1975 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 1976 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 1977 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 1978 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 1979 * a path discovery in milliseconds 1980 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1981 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 1982 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 1983 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1984 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 1985 * element 1986 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1987 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 1988 * element 1989 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 1990 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 1991 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 1992 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 1993 * announcements are transmitted 1994 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 1995 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 1996 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 1997 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 1998 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 1999 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 2000 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 2001 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 2002 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 2003 * station to establish a peer link 2004 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 2005 * 2006 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2007 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 2008 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 2009 * 2010 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 2011 * PREQs are transmitted. 2012 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 2013 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 2014 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 2015 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 2016 * setting for new peer links. 2017 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 2018 * after transmitting its beacon. 2019 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 2020 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 2021 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 2022 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 2023 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 2024 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 2025 * in the mesh path table 2026 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 2027 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 2028 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 2029 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 2030 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 2031 */ 2032 struct mesh_config { 2033 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 2034 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 2035 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 2036 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 2037 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 2038 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 2039 u8 element_ttl; 2040 bool auto_open_plinks; 2041 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 2042 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 2043 u32 path_refresh_time; 2044 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 2045 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 2046 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 2047 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 2048 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 2049 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 2050 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 2051 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 2052 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 2053 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 2054 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 2055 s32 rssi_threshold; 2056 u16 ht_opmode; 2057 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 2058 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 2059 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 2060 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 2061 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 2062 u32 plink_timeout; 2063 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 2064 }; 2065 2066 /** 2067 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 2068 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2069 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 2070 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 2071 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 2072 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 2073 * @path_metric: which metric to use 2074 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 2075 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 2076 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 2077 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 2078 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2079 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2080 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2081 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2082 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2083 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2084 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2085 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2086 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2087 * to operate on DFS channels. 2088 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2089 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2090 * 2091 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2092 */ 2093 struct mesh_setup { 2094 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2095 const u8 *mesh_id; 2096 u8 mesh_id_len; 2097 u8 sync_method; 2098 u8 path_sel_proto; 2099 u8 path_metric; 2100 u8 auth_id; 2101 const u8 *ie; 2102 u8 ie_len; 2103 bool is_authenticated; 2104 bool is_secure; 2105 bool user_mpm; 2106 u8 dtim_period; 2107 u16 beacon_interval; 2108 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2109 u32 basic_rates; 2110 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2111 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2112 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2113 }; 2114 2115 /** 2116 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2117 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2118 * 2119 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2120 */ 2121 struct ocb_setup { 2122 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2123 }; 2124 2125 /** 2126 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2127 * @ac: AC identifier 2128 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2129 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2130 * 1..32767] 2131 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2132 * 1..32767] 2133 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2134 */ 2135 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2136 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2137 u16 txop; 2138 u16 cwmin; 2139 u16 cwmax; 2140 u8 aifs; 2141 }; 2142 2143 /** 2144 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2145 * 2146 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2147 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2148 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2149 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2150 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2151 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2152 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2153 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2154 * in the wiphy structure. 2155 * 2156 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2157 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2158 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2159 * 2160 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2161 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2162 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2163 * to userspace. 2164 */ 2165 2166 /** 2167 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2168 * @ssid: the SSID 2169 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2170 */ 2171 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2172 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2173 u8 ssid_len; 2174 }; 2175 2176 /** 2177 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2178 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2179 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2180 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2181 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2182 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2183 * userspace will be notified of that 2184 */ 2185 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2186 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2187 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2188 bool aborted; 2189 }; 2190 2191 /** 2192 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2193 * 2194 * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for 2195 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2196 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2197 * which the above info relvant to 2198 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2199 * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used 2200 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2201 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2202 */ 2203 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2204 u32 short_ssid; 2205 u32 channel_idx; 2206 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2207 bool unsolicited_probe; 2208 bool short_ssid_valid; 2209 bool psc_no_listen; 2210 }; 2211 2212 /** 2213 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2214 * 2215 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2216 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2217 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2218 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2219 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2220 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2221 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2222 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2223 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2224 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2225 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2226 * %duration field. 2227 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2228 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2229 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2230 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2231 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2232 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2233 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2234 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2235 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2236 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2237 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2238 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2239 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2240 * true if this is the second scan request 2241 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2242 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2243 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2244 */ 2245 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2246 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2247 int n_ssids; 2248 u32 n_channels; 2249 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2250 const u8 *ie; 2251 size_t ie_len; 2252 u16 duration; 2253 bool duration_mandatory; 2254 u32 flags; 2255 2256 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2257 2258 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2259 2260 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2261 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2262 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2263 2264 /* internal */ 2265 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2266 unsigned long scan_start; 2267 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2268 bool notified; 2269 bool no_cck; 2270 bool scan_6ghz; 2271 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2272 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2273 2274 /* keep last */ 2275 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2276 }; 2277 2278 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2279 { 2280 int i; 2281 2282 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2283 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2284 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2285 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2286 } 2287 } 2288 2289 /** 2290 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2291 * 2292 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2293 * or no match (RSSI only) 2294 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2295 * or no match (RSSI only) 2296 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2297 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2298 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support 2299 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2300 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2301 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2302 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2303 * corresponding matchset. 2304 */ 2305 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2306 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2307 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2308 s32 rssi_thold; 2309 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2310 }; 2311 2312 /** 2313 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2314 * 2315 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2316 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2317 * infinite loop. 2318 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2319 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2320 */ 2321 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2322 u32 interval; 2323 u32 iterations; 2324 }; 2325 2326 /** 2327 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2328 * 2329 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2330 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2331 */ 2332 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2333 enum nl80211_band band; 2334 s8 delta; 2335 }; 2336 2337 /** 2338 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2339 * 2340 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2341 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2342 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2343 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2344 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2345 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2346 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2347 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2348 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2349 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2350 * (others are filtered out). 2351 * If ommited, all results are passed. 2352 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2353 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2354 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2355 * @dev: the interface 2356 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2357 * @channels: channels to scan 2358 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2359 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2360 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2361 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2362 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2363 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2364 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2365 * index must be executed first. 2366 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2367 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2368 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2369 * owned by a particular socket) 2370 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2371 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2372 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2373 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2374 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2375 * supported. 2376 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2377 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2378 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2379 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2380 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2381 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2382 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2383 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2384 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2385 * comparisions. 2386 */ 2387 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2388 u64 reqid; 2389 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2390 int n_ssids; 2391 u32 n_channels; 2392 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2393 const u8 *ie; 2394 size_t ie_len; 2395 u32 flags; 2396 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2397 int n_match_sets; 2398 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2399 u32 delay; 2400 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2401 int n_scan_plans; 2402 2403 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2404 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2405 2406 bool relative_rssi_set; 2407 s8 relative_rssi; 2408 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2409 2410 /* internal */ 2411 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2412 struct net_device *dev; 2413 unsigned long scan_start; 2414 bool report_results; 2415 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2416 u32 owner_nlportid; 2417 bool nl_owner_dead; 2418 struct list_head list; 2419 2420 /* keep last */ 2421 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2422 }; 2423 2424 /** 2425 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2426 * 2427 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2428 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2429 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2430 */ 2431 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2432 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2433 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2434 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2435 }; 2436 2437 /** 2438 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2439 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2440 * @scan_width: scan width that was used 2441 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2442 * signal type 2443 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2444 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2445 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2446 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2447 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2448 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2449 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2450 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2451 * by %parent_bssid. 2452 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2453 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2454 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2455 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2456 */ 2457 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2458 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2459 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2460 s32 signal; 2461 u64 boottime_ns; 2462 u64 parent_tsf; 2463 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2464 u8 chains; 2465 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2466 }; 2467 2468 /** 2469 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2470 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2471 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2472 * @len: length of the IEs 2473 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2474 * @data: IE data 2475 */ 2476 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2477 u64 tsf; 2478 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2479 int len; 2480 bool from_beacon; 2481 u8 data[]; 2482 }; 2483 2484 /** 2485 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2486 * 2487 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2488 * for use in scan results and similar. 2489 * 2490 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2491 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 2492 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2493 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2494 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2495 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2496 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2497 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2498 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2499 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2500 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2501 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2502 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2503 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2504 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2505 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2506 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2507 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2508 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2509 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2510 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2511 * (multi-BSSID support) 2512 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2513 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2514 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2515 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2516 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2517 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2518 */ 2519 struct cfg80211_bss { 2520 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2521 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2522 2523 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2524 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2525 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2526 2527 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2528 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2529 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2530 2531 s32 signal; 2532 2533 u16 beacon_interval; 2534 u16 capability; 2535 2536 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2537 u8 chains; 2538 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2539 2540 u8 bssid_index; 2541 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2542 2543 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2544 }; 2545 2546 /** 2547 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2548 * @bss: the bss to search 2549 * @id: the element ID 2550 * 2551 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2552 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2553 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2554 */ 2555 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2556 2557 /** 2558 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2559 * @bss: the bss to search 2560 * @id: the element ID 2561 * 2562 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2563 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2564 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2565 */ 2566 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2567 { 2568 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2569 } 2570 2571 2572 /** 2573 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2574 * 2575 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2576 * authentication. 2577 * 2578 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2579 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2580 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2581 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2582 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2583 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2584 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2585 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2586 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2587 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2588 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2589 * transaction sequence number field. 2590 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2591 */ 2592 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2593 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2594 const u8 *ie; 2595 size_t ie_len; 2596 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2597 const u8 *key; 2598 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2599 const u8 *auth_data; 2600 size_t auth_data_len; 2601 }; 2602 2603 /** 2604 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2605 * 2606 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2607 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2608 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 2609 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 2610 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 2611 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 2612 * request (connect callback). 2613 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE 2614 */ 2615 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 2616 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 2617 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 2618 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 2619 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 2620 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), 2621 }; 2622 2623 /** 2624 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 2625 * 2626 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2627 * (re)association. 2628 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 2629 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 2630 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 2631 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 2632 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 2633 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2634 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 2635 * @crypto: crypto settings 2636 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2637 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2638 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2639 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2640 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2641 * frame. 2642 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2643 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2644 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2645 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2646 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 2647 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 2648 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 2649 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 2650 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 2651 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 2652 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 2653 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2654 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 2655 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 2656 */ 2657 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 2658 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2659 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 2660 size_t ie_len; 2661 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2662 bool use_mfp; 2663 u32 flags; 2664 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2665 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2666 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 2667 const u8 *fils_kek; 2668 size_t fils_kek_len; 2669 const u8 *fils_nonces; 2670 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 2671 }; 2672 2673 /** 2674 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 2675 * 2676 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2677 * deauthentication. 2678 * 2679 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from 2680 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 2681 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2682 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 2683 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 2684 * do not set a deauth frame 2685 */ 2686 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 2687 const u8 *bssid; 2688 const u8 *ie; 2689 size_t ie_len; 2690 u16 reason_code; 2691 bool local_state_change; 2692 }; 2693 2694 /** 2695 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 2696 * 2697 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2698 * disassociation. 2699 * 2700 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from 2701 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 2702 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2703 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 2704 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 2705 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 2706 */ 2707 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 2708 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2709 const u8 *ie; 2710 size_t ie_len; 2711 u16 reason_code; 2712 bool local_state_change; 2713 }; 2714 2715 /** 2716 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 2717 * 2718 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 2719 * method. 2720 * 2721 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 2722 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 2723 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 2724 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 2725 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 2726 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 2727 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 2728 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 2729 * @ie_len: length of that 2730 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2731 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 2732 * after joining 2733 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 2734 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 2735 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 2736 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 2737 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2738 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2739 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2740 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2741 * to operate on DFS channels. 2742 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 2743 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 2744 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2745 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2746 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2747 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 2748 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 2749 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 2750 */ 2751 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 2752 const u8 *ssid; 2753 const u8 *bssid; 2754 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2755 const u8 *ie; 2756 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 2757 u16 beacon_interval; 2758 u32 basic_rates; 2759 bool channel_fixed; 2760 bool privacy; 2761 bool control_port; 2762 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2763 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2764 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2765 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2766 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2767 struct key_params *wep_keys; 2768 int wep_tx_key; 2769 }; 2770 2771 /** 2772 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 2773 * 2774 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 2775 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 2776 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 2777 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 2778 */ 2779 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 2780 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 2781 union { 2782 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 2783 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 2784 } param; 2785 }; 2786 2787 /** 2788 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 2789 * 2790 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2791 * authentication and association. 2792 * 2793 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 2794 * on scan results) 2795 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 2796 * %NULL if not specified 2797 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 2798 * results) 2799 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 2800 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 2801 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 2802 * to use. 2803 * @ssid: SSID 2804 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 2805 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2806 * @ie: IEs for association request 2807 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 2808 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 2809 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 2810 * @crypto: crypto settings 2811 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2812 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2813 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2814 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2815 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 2816 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 2817 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2818 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2819 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2820 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 2821 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 2822 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 2823 * networks. 2824 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 2825 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2826 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2827 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2828 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2829 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2830 * frame. 2831 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 2832 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 2833 * data IE. 2834 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 2835 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 2836 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 2837 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2838 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 2839 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 2840 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2841 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 2842 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 2843 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 2844 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 2845 * offload of 4-way handshake. 2846 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 2847 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 2848 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 2849 */ 2850 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 2851 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2852 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 2853 const u8 *bssid; 2854 const u8 *bssid_hint; 2855 const u8 *ssid; 2856 size_t ssid_len; 2857 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2858 const u8 *ie; 2859 size_t ie_len; 2860 bool privacy; 2861 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 2862 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2863 const u8 *key; 2864 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2865 u32 flags; 2866 int bg_scan_period; 2867 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2868 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2869 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 2870 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 2871 bool pbss; 2872 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 2873 const u8 *prev_bssid; 2874 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 2875 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 2876 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 2877 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 2878 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 2879 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 2880 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 2881 bool want_1x; 2882 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 2883 }; 2884 2885 /** 2886 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 2887 * 2888 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 2889 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 2890 * 2891 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 2892 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 2893 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 2894 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 2895 */ 2896 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 2897 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 2898 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 2899 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 2900 }; 2901 2902 /** 2903 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 2904 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 2905 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 2906 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 2907 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 2908 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 2909 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 2910 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 2911 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 2912 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 2913 */ 2914 enum wiphy_params_flags { 2915 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 2916 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 2917 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 2918 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 2919 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 2920 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 2921 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 2922 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 2923 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 2924 }; 2925 2926 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 2927 2928 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 2929 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 2930 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 2931 2932 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 2933 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 2934 2935 /** 2936 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 2937 * 2938 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 2939 * caching. 2940 * 2941 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 2942 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 2943 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 2944 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 2945 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 2946 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 2947 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 2948 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 2949 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 2950 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 2951 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 2952 * %NULL). 2953 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 2954 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 2955 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 2956 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 2957 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 2958 * used for it expires. 2959 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 2960 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 2961 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 2962 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 2963 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 2964 */ 2965 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 2966 const u8 *bssid; 2967 const u8 *pmkid; 2968 const u8 *pmk; 2969 size_t pmk_len; 2970 const u8 *ssid; 2971 size_t ssid_len; 2972 const u8 *cache_id; 2973 u32 pmk_lifetime; 2974 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 2975 }; 2976 2977 /** 2978 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 2979 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 2980 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 2981 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 2982 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 2983 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 2984 * 2985 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 2986 * memory, free @mask only! 2987 */ 2988 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 2989 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 2990 int pattern_len; 2991 int pkt_offset; 2992 }; 2993 2994 /** 2995 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 2996 * 2997 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 2998 * @src: source IP address 2999 * @dst: destination IP address 3000 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 3001 * @src_port: source port 3002 * @dst_port: destination port 3003 * @payload_len: data payload length 3004 * @payload: data payload buffer 3005 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 3006 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 3007 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 3008 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 3009 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 3010 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 3011 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 3012 */ 3013 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 3014 struct socket *sock; 3015 __be32 src, dst; 3016 u16 src_port, dst_port; 3017 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 3018 int payload_len; 3019 const u8 *payload; 3020 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 3021 u32 data_interval; 3022 u32 wake_len; 3023 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 3024 u32 tokens_size; 3025 /* must be last, variable member */ 3026 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 3027 }; 3028 3029 /** 3030 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 3031 * 3032 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 3033 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 3034 * operating as normal during suspend 3035 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 3036 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 3037 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 3038 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3039 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 3040 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 3041 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 3042 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 3043 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 3044 * NULL if not configured. 3045 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 3046 */ 3047 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 3048 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3049 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3050 rfkill_release; 3051 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3052 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 3053 int n_patterns; 3054 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 3055 }; 3056 3057 /** 3058 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 3059 * 3060 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 3061 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 3062 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 3063 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 3064 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 3065 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3066 */ 3067 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 3068 int delay; 3069 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 3070 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3071 int n_patterns; 3072 }; 3073 3074 /** 3075 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 3076 * 3077 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 3078 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 3079 * @n_rules: number of rules 3080 */ 3081 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3082 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3083 int n_rules; 3084 }; 3085 3086 /** 3087 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3088 * 3089 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3090 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3091 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3092 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3093 * occurred (in MHz) 3094 */ 3095 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3096 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3097 int n_channels; 3098 u32 channels[]; 3099 }; 3100 3101 /** 3102 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3103 * 3104 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3105 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3106 * match information. 3107 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3108 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3109 */ 3110 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3111 int n_matches; 3112 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3113 }; 3114 3115 /** 3116 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3117 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3118 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3119 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3120 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3121 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3122 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3123 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3124 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3125 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3126 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3127 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3128 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3129 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3130 * it is. 3131 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3132 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3133 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3134 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3135 */ 3136 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3137 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3138 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3139 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3140 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3141 s32 pattern_idx; 3142 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3143 const void *packet; 3144 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3145 }; 3146 3147 /** 3148 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3149 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3150 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3151 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3152 * @kek_len: length of kek 3153 * @kck_len length of kck 3154 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3155 */ 3156 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3157 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3158 u32 akm; 3159 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3160 }; 3161 3162 /** 3163 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3164 * 3165 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3166 * 3167 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3168 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3169 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3170 */ 3171 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3172 u16 md; 3173 const u8 *ie; 3174 size_t ie_len; 3175 }; 3176 3177 /** 3178 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3179 * 3180 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3181 * 3182 * @chan: channel to use 3183 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required 3184 * @wait: duration for ROC 3185 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3186 * @len: buffer length 3187 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3188 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3189 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3190 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3191 */ 3192 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3193 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3194 bool offchan; 3195 unsigned int wait; 3196 const u8 *buf; 3197 size_t len; 3198 bool no_cck; 3199 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3200 int n_csa_offsets; 3201 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3202 }; 3203 3204 /** 3205 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3206 * 3207 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3208 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3209 */ 3210 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3211 u8 dscp; 3212 u8 up; 3213 }; 3214 3215 /** 3216 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3217 * 3218 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3219 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3220 */ 3221 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3222 u8 low; 3223 u8 high; 3224 }; 3225 3226 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3227 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3228 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3229 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3230 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3231 3232 /** 3233 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3234 * 3235 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3236 * 3237 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3238 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3239 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3240 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3241 */ 3242 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3243 u8 num_des; 3244 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3245 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3246 }; 3247 3248 /** 3249 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3250 * 3251 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3252 * 3253 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3254 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3255 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3256 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3257 */ 3258 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3259 u8 master_pref; 3260 u8 bands; 3261 }; 3262 3263 /** 3264 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3265 * configuration 3266 * 3267 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3268 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3269 */ 3270 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3271 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3272 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3273 }; 3274 3275 /** 3276 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3277 * 3278 * @filter: the content of the filter 3279 * @len: the length of the filter 3280 */ 3281 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3282 const u8 *filter; 3283 u8 len; 3284 }; 3285 3286 /** 3287 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3288 * 3289 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3290 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3291 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3292 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3293 * implementation specific. 3294 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3295 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3296 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3297 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up 3298 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3299 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3300 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3301 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3302 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3303 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3304 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3305 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3306 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3307 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3308 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3309 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3310 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3311 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3312 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3313 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3314 */ 3315 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3316 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3317 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3318 u8 publish_type; 3319 bool close_range; 3320 bool publish_bcast; 3321 bool subscribe_active; 3322 u8 followup_id; 3323 u8 followup_reqid; 3324 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3325 u32 ttl; 3326 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3327 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3328 bool srf_include; 3329 const u8 *srf_bf; 3330 u8 srf_bf_len; 3331 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3332 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3333 int srf_num_macs; 3334 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3335 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3336 u8 num_tx_filters; 3337 u8 num_rx_filters; 3338 u8 instance_id; 3339 u64 cookie; 3340 }; 3341 3342 /** 3343 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3344 * 3345 * @aa: authenticator address 3346 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3347 * @pmk: the PMK material 3348 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3349 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3350 * holds PMK-R0. 3351 */ 3352 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3353 const u8 *aa; 3354 u8 pmk_len; 3355 const u8 *pmk; 3356 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3357 }; 3358 3359 /** 3360 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3361 * 3362 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3363 * 3364 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3365 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3366 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3367 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3368 * authentication response command interface. 3369 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3370 * authentication response command interface. 3371 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3372 * authentication request event interface. 3373 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3374 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3375 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3376 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3377 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3378 */ 3379 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3380 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3381 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3382 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3383 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3384 u16 status; 3385 const u8 *pmkid; 3386 }; 3387 3388 /** 3389 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3390 * 3391 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3392 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3393 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3394 * answered 3395 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3396 * successfully answered 3397 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3398 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3399 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3400 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3401 * of how much time the responder was busy 3402 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3403 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3404 * the responder 3405 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3406 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3407 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3408 */ 3409 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3410 u32 filled; 3411 u32 success_num; 3412 u32 partial_num; 3413 u32 failed_num; 3414 u32 asap_num; 3415 u32 non_asap_num; 3416 u64 total_duration_ms; 3417 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3418 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3419 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3420 }; 3421 3422 /** 3423 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3424 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3425 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3426 * reason than just "failure" 3427 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3428 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3429 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3430 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3431 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3432 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3433 * by the responder 3434 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3435 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3436 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3437 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3438 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3439 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3440 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3441 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3442 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3443 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3444 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3445 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3446 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3447 * the square root of the variance) 3448 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3449 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3450 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3451 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3452 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3453 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3454 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3455 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3456 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3457 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3458 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3459 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3460 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3461 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3462 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3463 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3464 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3465 */ 3466 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3467 const u8 *lci; 3468 const u8 *civicloc; 3469 unsigned int lci_len; 3470 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3471 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3472 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3473 s16 burst_index; 3474 u8 busy_retry_time; 3475 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3476 u8 burst_duration; 3477 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3478 s32 rssi_avg; 3479 s32 rssi_spread; 3480 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3481 s64 rtt_avg; 3482 s64 rtt_variance; 3483 s64 rtt_spread; 3484 s64 dist_avg; 3485 s64 dist_variance; 3486 s64 dist_spread; 3487 3488 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3489 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3490 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3491 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3492 tx_rate_valid:1, 3493 rx_rate_valid:1, 3494 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3495 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3496 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3497 dist_avg_valid:1, 3498 dist_variance_valid:1, 3499 dist_spread_valid:1; 3500 }; 3501 3502 /** 3503 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3504 * @addr: address of the peer 3505 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3506 * measurement was made) 3507 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3508 * @status: status of the measurement 3509 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3510 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3511 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3512 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3513 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3514 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3515 */ 3516 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3517 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3518 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3519 3520 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3521 3522 u8 final:1, 3523 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3524 3525 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3526 3527 union { 3528 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3529 }; 3530 }; 3531 3532 /** 3533 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3534 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3535 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3536 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3537 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3538 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3539 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3540 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3541 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3542 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3543 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3544 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3545 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3546 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3547 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3548 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3549 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3550 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either 3551 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. 3552 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to 3553 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if 3554 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. 3555 * 3556 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3557 */ 3558 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3559 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3560 u16 burst_period; 3561 u8 requested:1, 3562 asap:1, 3563 request_lci:1, 3564 request_civicloc:1, 3565 trigger_based:1, 3566 non_trigger_based:1, 3567 lmr_feedback:1; 3568 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3569 u8 burst_duration; 3570 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3571 u8 ftmr_retries; 3572 u8 bss_color; 3573 }; 3574 3575 /** 3576 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 3577 * @addr: MAC address 3578 * @chandef: channel to use 3579 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 3580 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 3581 */ 3582 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 3583 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3584 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3585 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 3586 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 3587 }; 3588 3589 /** 3590 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 3591 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 3592 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 3593 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 3594 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 3595 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 3596 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 3597 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 3598 * be taken from the @mac_addr 3599 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 3600 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 3601 * zero it means there's no timeout 3602 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 3603 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 3604 */ 3605 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 3606 u64 cookie; 3607 void *drv_data; 3608 u32 n_peers; 3609 u32 nl_portid; 3610 3611 u32 timeout; 3612 3613 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3614 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3615 3616 struct list_head list; 3617 3618 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[]; 3619 }; 3620 3621 /** 3622 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 3623 * 3624 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 3625 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 3626 * 3627 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 3628 * 3629 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 3630 * has to be done. 3631 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 3632 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 3633 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 3634 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 3635 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 3636 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 3637 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 3638 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 3639 */ 3640 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 3641 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3642 u16 status; 3643 const u8 *ie; 3644 size_t ie_len; 3645 }; 3646 3647 /** 3648 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 3649 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3650 * for the entire device 3651 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3652 * for the given interface 3653 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 3654 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 3655 * for these subtypes 3656 */ 3657 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 3658 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 3659 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 3660 }; 3661 3662 /** 3663 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 3664 * 3665 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 3666 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 3667 * 3668 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 3669 * on success or a negative error code. 3670 * 3671 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be 3672 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied 3673 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, 3674 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. 3675 * 3676 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 3677 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 3678 * configured for the device. 3679 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 3680 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 3681 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 3682 * the device. 3683 * 3684 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 3685 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 3686 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 3687 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 3688 * also set the address member in the wdev. 3689 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3690 * 3691 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 3692 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3693 * 3694 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 3695 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 3696 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3697 * 3698 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 3699 * when adding a group key. 3700 * 3701 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 3702 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 3703 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 3704 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 3705 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 3706 * 3707 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 3708 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. 3709 * 3710 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface 3711 * 3712 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface 3713 * 3714 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface 3715 * 3716 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 3717 * 3718 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 3719 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 3720 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 3721 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 3722 * 3723 * @add_station: Add a new station. 3724 * @del_station: Remove a station 3725 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 3726 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 3727 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 3728 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 3729 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 3730 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 3731 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3732 * 3733 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 3734 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 3735 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 3736 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 3737 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3738 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 3739 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3740 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 3741 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3742 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 3743 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3744 * 3745 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 3746 * 3747 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 3748 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 3749 * set, and which to leave alone. 3750 * 3751 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 3752 * 3753 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 3754 * 3755 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 3756 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 3757 * join the mesh instead. 3758 * 3759 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 3760 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 3761 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 3762 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 3763 * 3764 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 3765 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 3766 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 3767 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 3768 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 3769 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 3770 * 3771 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 3772 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3773 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 3774 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3775 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 3776 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3777 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 3778 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3779 * 3780 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 3781 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 3782 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 3783 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 3784 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 3785 * was received. 3786 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 3787 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 3788 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 3789 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 3790 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 3791 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 3792 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 3793 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 3794 * indication of requesting reassociation. 3795 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 3796 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 3797 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3798 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 3799 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 3800 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 3801 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 3802 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 3803 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 3804 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 3805 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3806 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 3807 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 3808 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 3809 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 3810 * 3811 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 3812 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 3813 * to a merge. 3814 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3815 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 3816 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3817 * 3818 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 3819 * MESH mode) 3820 * 3821 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 3822 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 3823 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 3824 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 3825 * 3826 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 3827 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 3828 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 3829 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 3830 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 3831 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 3832 * return 0 if successful 3833 * 3834 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 3835 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 3836 * 3837 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 3838 * 3839 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 3840 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 3841 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 3842 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 3843 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 3844 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 3845 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 3846 * the duration value. 3847 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 3848 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 3849 * frame on another channel 3850 * 3851 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 3852 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 3853 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 3854 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 3855 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 3856 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 3857 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 3858 * 3859 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 3860 * 3861 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 3862 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 3863 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 3864 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 3865 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 3866 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 3867 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 3868 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 3869 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 3870 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 3871 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 3872 * disabled.) 3873 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 3874 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 3875 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 3876 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 3877 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 3878 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 3879 * thresholds. 3880 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 3881 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 3882 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 3883 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 3884 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 3885 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 3886 * stop (when this method returns 0). 3887 * 3888 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 3889 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 3890 * 3891 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3892 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3893 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3894 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3895 * 3896 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3897 * 3898 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 3899 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 3900 * 3901 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 3902 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 3903 * 3904 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 3905 * 3906 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 3907 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 3908 * current monitoring channel. 3909 * 3910 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 3911 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 3912 * 3913 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 3914 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 3915 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 3916 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 3917 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 3918 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 3919 * 3920 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 3921 * 3922 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 3923 * was finished on another phy. 3924 * 3925 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 3926 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 3927 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 3928 * 3929 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 3930 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 3931 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 3932 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 3933 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 3934 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 3935 * 3936 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 3937 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 3938 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 3939 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 3940 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 3941 * as soon as possible. 3942 * 3943 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 3944 * 3945 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 3946 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 3947 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 3948 * 3949 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 3950 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 3951 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 3952 * account. 3953 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 3954 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 3955 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 3956 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 3957 * rejected) 3958 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 3959 * 3960 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 3961 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3962 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 3963 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3964 * 3965 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 3966 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 3967 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 3968 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 3969 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 3970 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 3971 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 3972 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 3973 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 3974 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 3975 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 3976 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 3977 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 3978 * provided @nan_func. 3979 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 3980 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 3981 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 3982 * All other parameters must be ignored. 3983 * 3984 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 3985 * 3986 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 3987 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 3988 * 3989 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 3990 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 3991 * upon which the driver should clear it. 3992 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3993 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 3994 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3995 * 3996 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 3997 * user space 3998 * 3999 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 4000 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 4001 * 4002 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4003 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4004 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 4005 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 4006 * 4007 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 4008 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 4009 * DH IE through this interface. 4010 * 4011 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 4012 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 4013 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 4014 * This callback may sleep. 4015 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 4016 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 4017 * 4018 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4019 * 4020 * @color_change: Initiate a color change. 4021 */ 4022 struct cfg80211_ops { 4023 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 4024 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4025 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 4026 4027 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4028 const char *name, 4029 unsigned char name_assign_type, 4030 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4031 struct vif_params *params); 4032 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4033 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4034 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4035 struct net_device *dev, 4036 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4037 struct vif_params *params); 4038 4039 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4040 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 4041 struct key_params *params); 4042 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4043 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 4044 void *cookie, 4045 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 4046 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4047 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr); 4048 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4049 struct net_device *netdev, 4050 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 4051 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4052 struct net_device *netdev, 4053 u8 key_index); 4054 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4055 struct net_device *netdev, 4056 u8 key_index); 4057 4058 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4059 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 4060 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4061 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); 4062 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4063 4064 4065 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4066 const u8 *mac, 4067 struct station_parameters *params); 4068 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4069 struct station_del_parameters *params); 4070 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4071 const u8 *mac, 4072 struct station_parameters *params); 4073 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4074 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4075 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4076 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4077 4078 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4079 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4080 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4081 const u8 *dst); 4082 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4083 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4084 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4085 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4086 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4087 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 4088 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4089 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4090 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4091 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4092 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 4093 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4094 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4095 struct net_device *dev, 4096 struct mesh_config *conf); 4097 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4098 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4099 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4100 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4101 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4102 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4103 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4104 4105 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4106 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4107 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4108 4109 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4110 struct bss_parameters *params); 4111 4112 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4113 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4114 4115 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4116 struct net_device *dev, 4117 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4118 4119 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4120 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4121 4122 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4123 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4124 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4125 4126 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4127 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4128 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4129 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4130 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4131 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4132 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4133 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4134 4135 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4136 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4137 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4138 struct net_device *dev, 4139 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4140 u32 changed); 4141 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4142 u16 reason_code); 4143 4144 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4145 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4146 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4147 4148 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4149 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4150 4151 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4152 4153 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4154 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4155 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4156 int *dbm); 4157 4158 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4159 4160 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4161 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4162 void *data, int len); 4163 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4164 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4165 void *data, int len); 4166 #endif 4167 4168 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4169 struct net_device *dev, 4170 const u8 *peer, 4171 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4172 4173 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4174 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4175 4176 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4177 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4178 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4179 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4180 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4181 4182 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4183 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4184 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4185 unsigned int duration, 4186 u64 *cookie); 4187 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4188 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4189 u64 cookie); 4190 4191 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4192 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4193 u64 *cookie); 4194 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4195 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4196 u64 cookie); 4197 4198 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4199 bool enabled, int timeout); 4200 4201 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4202 struct net_device *dev, 4203 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4204 4205 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4206 struct net_device *dev, 4207 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4208 4209 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4210 struct net_device *dev, 4211 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4212 4213 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4214 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4215 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4216 4217 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4218 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4219 4220 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4221 struct net_device *dev, 4222 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4223 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4224 u64 reqid); 4225 4226 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4227 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4228 4229 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4230 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, 4231 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability, 4232 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4233 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4234 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4235 4236 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4237 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4238 4239 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4240 struct net_device *dev, 4241 u16 noack_map); 4242 4243 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4244 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4245 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4246 4247 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4248 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4249 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4250 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4251 4252 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4253 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4254 4255 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4256 struct net_device *dev, 4257 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4258 u32 cac_time_ms); 4259 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4260 struct net_device *dev); 4261 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4262 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4263 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4264 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4265 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4266 u16 duration); 4267 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4268 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4269 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4270 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4271 4272 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4273 struct net_device *dev, 4274 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4275 4276 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4277 struct net_device *dev, 4278 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4279 4280 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4281 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4282 4283 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4284 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4285 u16 admitted_time); 4286 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4287 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4288 4289 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4290 struct net_device *dev, 4291 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4292 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4293 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4294 struct net_device *dev, 4295 const u8 *addr); 4296 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4297 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4298 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4299 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4300 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4301 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4302 u64 cookie); 4303 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4304 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4305 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4306 u32 changes); 4307 4308 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4309 struct net_device *dev, 4310 const bool enabled); 4311 4312 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4313 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4314 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4315 4316 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4317 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4318 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4319 const u8 *aa); 4320 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4321 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4322 4323 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4324 struct net_device *dev, 4325 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4326 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4327 const bool noencrypt, 4328 u64 *cookie); 4329 4330 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4331 struct net_device *dev, 4332 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4333 4334 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4335 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4336 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4337 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4338 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4339 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4340 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4341 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4342 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4343 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4344 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4345 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4346 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4347 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4348 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4349 struct net_device *dev, 4350 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params); 4351 }; 4352 4353 /* 4354 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4355 * and registration/helper functions 4356 */ 4357 4358 /** 4359 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4360 * 4361 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4362 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4363 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4364 * wiphy at all 4365 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4366 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4367 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4368 * reason to override the default 4369 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4370 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4371 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4372 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4373 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4374 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4375 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4376 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4377 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4378 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4379 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4380 * firmware. 4381 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4382 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4383 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4384 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4385 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4386 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4387 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4388 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4389 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4390 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4391 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4392 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4393 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4394 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4395 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4396 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4397 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4398 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4399 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation 4400 * before connection. 4401 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4402 */ 4403 enum wiphy_flags { 4404 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4405 /* use hole at 1 */ 4406 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4407 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4408 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4409 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4410 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4411 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4412 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4413 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4414 /* use hole at 11 */ 4415 /* use hole at 12 */ 4416 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4417 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4418 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4419 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4420 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4421 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4422 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4423 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4424 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4425 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4426 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4427 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24), 4428 }; 4429 4430 /** 4431 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4432 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4433 * @types: interface types (bits) 4434 */ 4435 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4436 u16 max; 4437 u16 types; 4438 }; 4439 4440 /** 4441 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4442 * 4443 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4444 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4445 * 4446 * Examples: 4447 * 4448 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4449 * 4450 * .. code-block:: c 4451 * 4452 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4453 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4454 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, }, 4455 * }; 4456 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4457 * .limits = limits1, 4458 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4459 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4460 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4461 * }; 4462 * 4463 * 4464 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4465 * 4466 * .. code-block:: c 4467 * 4468 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4469 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4470 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4471 * }; 4472 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4473 * .limits = limits2, 4474 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4475 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4476 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4477 * }; 4478 * 4479 * 4480 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4481 * 4482 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4483 * 4484 * .. code-block:: c 4485 * 4486 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4487 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4488 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 4489 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 4490 * }; 4491 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 4492 * .limits = limits3, 4493 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 4494 * .max_interfaces = 4, 4495 * .num_different_channels = 2, 4496 * }; 4497 * 4498 */ 4499 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 4500 /** 4501 * @limits: 4502 * limits for the given interface types 4503 */ 4504 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 4505 4506 /** 4507 * @num_different_channels: 4508 * can use up to this many different channels 4509 */ 4510 u32 num_different_channels; 4511 4512 /** 4513 * @max_interfaces: 4514 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 4515 */ 4516 u16 max_interfaces; 4517 4518 /** 4519 * @n_limits: 4520 * number of limitations 4521 */ 4522 u8 n_limits; 4523 4524 /** 4525 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 4526 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 4527 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 4528 */ 4529 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 4530 4531 /** 4532 * @radar_detect_widths: 4533 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 4534 */ 4535 u8 radar_detect_widths; 4536 4537 /** 4538 * @radar_detect_regions: 4539 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 4540 */ 4541 u8 radar_detect_regions; 4542 4543 /** 4544 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 4545 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 4546 * 4547 * = 0 4548 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 4549 * > 0 4550 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 4551 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 4552 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 4553 */ 4554 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 4555 }; 4556 4557 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 4558 u16 tx, rx; 4559 }; 4560 4561 /** 4562 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 4563 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 4564 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 4565 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 4566 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 4567 * packet should be preserved in that case 4568 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 4569 * (see nl80211.h) 4570 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 4571 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 4572 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 4573 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 4574 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 4575 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 4576 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 4577 */ 4578 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 4579 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 4580 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 4581 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 4582 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 4583 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 4584 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 4585 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 4586 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 4587 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 4588 }; 4589 4590 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 4591 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 4592 u32 data_payload_max; 4593 u32 data_interval_max; 4594 u32 wake_payload_max; 4595 bool seq; 4596 }; 4597 4598 /** 4599 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 4600 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 4601 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 4602 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4603 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4604 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4605 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4606 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 4607 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 4608 * scheduled scans. 4609 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 4610 * details. 4611 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 4612 */ 4613 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 4614 u32 flags; 4615 int n_patterns; 4616 int pattern_max_len; 4617 int pattern_min_len; 4618 int max_pkt_offset; 4619 int max_nd_match_sets; 4620 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 4621 }; 4622 4623 /** 4624 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 4625 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 4626 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4627 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 4628 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4629 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4630 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4631 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4632 */ 4633 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 4634 int n_rules; 4635 int max_delay; 4636 int n_patterns; 4637 int pattern_max_len; 4638 int pattern_min_len; 4639 int max_pkt_offset; 4640 }; 4641 4642 /** 4643 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 4644 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 4645 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 4646 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 4647 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 4648 */ 4649 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 4650 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 4651 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 4652 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 4653 }; 4654 4655 /** 4656 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 4657 * 4658 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 4659 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 4660 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 4661 * 4662 */ 4663 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 4664 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 4665 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 4666 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 4667 }; 4668 4669 /** 4670 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 4671 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 4672 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 4673 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 4674 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 4675 */ 4676 4677 struct sta_opmode_info { 4678 u32 changed; 4679 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 4680 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 4681 u8 rx_nss; 4682 }; 4683 4684 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 4685 4686 /** 4687 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 4688 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 4689 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 4690 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 4691 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 4692 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 4693 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 4694 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 4695 * dumpit calls. 4696 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 4697 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 4698 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 4699 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 4700 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 4701 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 4702 * are used with dump requests. 4703 */ 4704 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 4705 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 4706 u32 flags; 4707 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4708 const void *data, int data_len); 4709 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4710 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 4711 unsigned long *storage); 4712 const struct nla_policy *policy; 4713 unsigned int maxattr; 4714 }; 4715 4716 /** 4717 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 4718 * @iftype: interface type 4719 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4720 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 4721 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 4722 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 4723 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 4724 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4725 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4726 */ 4727 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 4728 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 4729 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 4730 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 4731 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4732 }; 4733 4734 /** 4735 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 4736 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 4737 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 4738 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 4739 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 4740 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 4741 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 4742 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 4743 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 4744 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 4745 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 4746 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 4747 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 4748 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 4749 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 4750 * not limited) 4751 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4752 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4753 */ 4754 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 4755 unsigned int max_peers; 4756 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 4757 randomize_mac_addr:1; 4758 4759 struct { 4760 u32 preambles; 4761 u32 bandwidths; 4762 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 4763 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 4764 u8 supported:1, 4765 asap:1, 4766 non_asap:1, 4767 request_lci:1, 4768 request_civicloc:1, 4769 trigger_based:1, 4770 non_trigger_based:1; 4771 } ftm; 4772 }; 4773 4774 /** 4775 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 4776 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 4777 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 4778 * 4779 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 4780 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 4781 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4782 */ 4783 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 4784 u16 iftypes_mask; 4785 const u32 *akm_suites; 4786 int n_akm_suites; 4787 }; 4788 4789 /** 4790 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 4791 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device 4792 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 4793 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 4794 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 4795 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 4796 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 4797 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 4798 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 4799 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 4800 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 4801 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 4802 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 4803 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 4804 * iftype_akm_suites. 4805 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4806 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 4807 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 4808 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 4809 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 4810 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 4811 * suites are specified separately. 4812 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 4813 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 4814 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 4815 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 4816 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 4817 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 4818 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 4819 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 4820 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 4821 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 4822 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 4823 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 4824 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 4825 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 4826 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 4827 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 4828 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 4829 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 4830 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 4831 * unregister hardware 4832 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 4833 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 4834 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 4835 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 4836 * (see below). 4837 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 4838 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 4839 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 4840 * must be set by driver 4841 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 4842 * list single interface types. 4843 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 4844 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 4845 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 4846 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 4847 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 4848 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 4849 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 4850 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 4851 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 4852 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 4853 * this variable determines its size 4854 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 4855 * any given scan 4856 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 4857 * the device can run concurrently. 4858 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 4859 * for in any given scheduled scan 4860 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 4861 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 4862 * supported. 4863 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 4864 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 4865 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 4866 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 4867 * scans 4868 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 4869 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 4870 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 4871 * single scan plan supported by the device. 4872 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 4873 * scan plan supported by the device. 4874 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 4875 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 4876 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 4877 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 4878 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 4879 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 4880 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 4881 * 4882 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 4883 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 4884 * type 4885 * 4886 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4887 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4888 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 4889 * 4890 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4891 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4892 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 4893 * 4894 * @probe_resp_offload: 4895 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 4896 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 4897 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 4898 * 4899 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 4900 * may request, if implemented. 4901 * 4902 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 4903 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 4904 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 4905 * to the suspend() operation instead. 4906 * 4907 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 4908 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 4909 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4910 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 4911 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4912 * 4913 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 4914 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 4915 * 4916 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 4917 * supports for ACL. 4918 * 4919 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4920 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 4921 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 4922 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 4923 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 4924 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 4925 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 4926 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4927 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4928 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 4929 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 4930 * capabilities are specified separately. 4931 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 4932 * 4933 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 4934 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 4935 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 4936 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 4937 * 4938 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 4939 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 4940 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 4941 * some cases, but may not always reach. 4942 * 4943 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 4944 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 4945 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 4946 * infinite. 4947 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 4948 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 4949 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 4950 * 4951 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 4952 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 4953 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 4954 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 4955 * 4956 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 4957 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 4958 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 4959 * 4960 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 4961 * wake_tx_queue 4962 * 4963 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 4964 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 4965 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 4966 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 4967 * 4968 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 4969 * 4970 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 4971 * device has 4972 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4973 * supported by the driver for each vif 4974 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4975 * supported by the driver for each peer 4976 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 4977 * long/short retry configuration 4978 * 4979 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 4980 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 4981 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 4982 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities 4983 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure 4984 */ 4985 struct wiphy { 4986 struct mutex mtx; 4987 4988 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 4989 4990 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4991 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 4992 4993 struct mac_address *addresses; 4994 4995 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 4996 4997 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 4998 int n_iface_combinations; 4999 u16 software_iftypes; 5000 5001 u16 n_addresses; 5002 5003 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 5004 u16 interface_modes; 5005 5006 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 5007 5008 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 5009 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 5010 5011 u32 ap_sme_capa; 5012 5013 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 5014 5015 int bss_priv_size; 5016 u8 max_scan_ssids; 5017 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 5018 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 5019 u8 max_match_sets; 5020 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 5021 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 5022 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 5023 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 5024 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 5025 5026 int n_cipher_suites; 5027 const u32 *cipher_suites; 5028 5029 int n_akm_suites; 5030 const u32 *akm_suites; 5031 5032 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 5033 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 5034 5035 u8 retry_short; 5036 u8 retry_long; 5037 u32 frag_threshold; 5038 u32 rts_threshold; 5039 u8 coverage_class; 5040 5041 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 5042 u32 hw_version; 5043 5044 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 5045 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 5046 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 5047 #endif 5048 5049 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 5050 5051 u8 max_num_pmkids; 5052 5053 u32 available_antennas_tx; 5054 u32 available_antennas_rx; 5055 5056 u32 probe_resp_offload; 5057 5058 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 5059 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5060 5061 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 5062 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 5063 5064 const void *privid; 5065 5066 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 5067 5068 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5069 struct regulatory_request *request); 5070 5071 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 5072 5073 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 5074 5075 struct device dev; 5076 5077 bool registered; 5078 5079 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 5080 5081 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 5082 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 5083 5084 struct list_head wdev_list; 5085 5086 possible_net_t _net; 5087 5088 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5089 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 5090 #endif 5091 5092 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 5093 5094 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 5095 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 5096 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 5097 5098 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 5099 5100 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5101 5102 u32 bss_select_support; 5103 5104 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5105 5106 u32 txq_limit; 5107 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5108 u32 txq_quantum; 5109 5110 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5111 5112 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5113 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5114 5115 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5116 5117 struct { 5118 u64 peer, vif; 5119 u8 max_retry; 5120 } tid_config_support; 5121 5122 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5123 5124 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; 5125 5126 struct rfkill *rfkill; 5127 5128 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5129 }; 5130 5131 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5132 { 5133 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5134 } 5135 5136 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5137 { 5138 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5139 } 5140 5141 /** 5142 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5143 * 5144 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5145 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5146 */ 5147 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5148 { 5149 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5150 return &wiphy->priv; 5151 } 5152 5153 /** 5154 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5155 * 5156 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5157 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5158 */ 5159 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5160 { 5161 BUG_ON(!priv); 5162 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5163 } 5164 5165 /** 5166 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5167 * 5168 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5169 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5170 */ 5171 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5172 { 5173 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5174 } 5175 5176 /** 5177 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5178 * 5179 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5180 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5181 */ 5182 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5183 { 5184 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5185 } 5186 5187 /** 5188 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5189 * 5190 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5191 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5192 */ 5193 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5194 { 5195 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5196 } 5197 5198 /** 5199 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5200 * 5201 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5202 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5203 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5204 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5205 * 5206 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5207 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5208 * 5209 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5210 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5211 */ 5212 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5213 const char *requested_name); 5214 5215 /** 5216 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5217 * 5218 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5219 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5220 * 5221 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5222 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5223 * 5224 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5225 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5226 */ 5227 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5228 int sizeof_priv) 5229 { 5230 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5231 } 5232 5233 /** 5234 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5235 * 5236 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5237 * 5238 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5239 */ 5240 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5241 5242 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ 5243 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) 5244 5245 /** 5246 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking 5247 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5248 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5249 * 5250 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() 5251 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). 5252 */ 5253 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ 5254 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5255 5256 /** 5257 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx 5258 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5259 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5260 * 5261 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the 5262 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. 5263 */ 5264 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ 5265 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5266 5267 /** 5268 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy 5269 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from 5270 */ 5271 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5272 5273 /** 5274 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5275 * 5276 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5277 * 5278 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5279 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5280 * request that is being handled. 5281 */ 5282 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5283 5284 /** 5285 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5286 * 5287 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5288 */ 5289 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5290 5291 /* internal structs */ 5292 struct cfg80211_conn; 5293 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5294 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5295 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5296 5297 /** 5298 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy 5299 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock 5300 * 5301 * This is mostly exposed so it can be done around registering and 5302 * unregistering netdevs that aren't created through cfg80211 calls, 5303 * since that requires locking in cfg80211 when the notifiers is 5304 * called, but that cannot differentiate which way it's called. 5305 * 5306 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. 5307 */ 5308 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5309 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) 5310 { 5311 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); 5312 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); 5313 } 5314 5315 /** 5316 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again 5317 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock 5318 */ 5319 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5320 __releases(&wiphy->mtx) 5321 { 5322 __release(&wiphy->mtx); 5323 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); 5324 } 5325 5326 /** 5327 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5328 * 5329 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5330 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5331 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5332 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5333 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, 5334 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or 5335 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops 5336 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) 5337 * 5338 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 5339 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 5340 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 5341 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 5342 * 5343 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 5344 * @iftype: interface type 5345 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 5346 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock 5347 * for the notifier 5348 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 5349 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 5350 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 5351 * wireless device if it has no netdev 5352 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5353 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track 5354 * the user-set channel definition. 5355 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to 5356 * track the channel to be used for AP later 5357 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5358 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5359 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5360 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5361 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5362 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 5363 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 5364 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 5365 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 5366 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 5367 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 5368 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 5369 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 5370 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 5371 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 5372 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 5373 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 5374 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 5375 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 5376 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 5377 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 5378 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 5379 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list 5380 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 5381 * need to propagate the update to the driver 5382 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers 5383 * and some API functions require it held 5384 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 5385 * beacons, 0 when not valid 5386 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 5387 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 5388 * the P2P Device. 5389 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 5390 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 5391 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 5392 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 5393 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 5394 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 5395 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 5396 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 5397 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 5398 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 5399 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 5400 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 5401 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 5402 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID 5403 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel 5404 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 5405 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 5406 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 5407 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 5408 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 5409 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 5410 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 5411 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 5412 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 5413 * unprotected beacon report 5414 */ 5415 struct wireless_dev { 5416 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5417 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5418 5419 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 5420 struct list_head list; 5421 struct net_device *netdev; 5422 5423 u32 identifier; 5424 5425 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 5426 spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock; 5427 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 5428 5429 struct mutex mtx; 5430 5431 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; 5432 5433 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 5434 5435 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 5436 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5437 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len; 5438 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 5439 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 5440 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 5441 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 5442 5443 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 5444 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5445 5446 struct list_head event_list; 5447 spinlock_t event_lock; 5448 5449 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */ 5450 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 5451 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 5452 5453 bool ibss_fixed; 5454 bool ibss_dfs_possible; 5455 5456 bool ps; 5457 int ps_timeout; 5458 5459 int beacon_interval; 5460 5461 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 5462 5463 u32 owner_nlportid; 5464 bool nl_owner_dead; 5465 5466 bool cac_started; 5467 unsigned long cac_start_time; 5468 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 5469 5470 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5471 /* wext data */ 5472 struct { 5473 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 5474 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 5475 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 5476 const u8 *ie; 5477 size_t ie_len; 5478 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5479 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5480 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5481 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 5482 bool prev_bssid_valid; 5483 } wext; 5484 #endif 5485 5486 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config; 5487 5488 struct list_head pmsr_list; 5489 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 5490 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 5491 5492 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 5493 }; 5494 5495 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5496 { 5497 if (wdev->netdev) 5498 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 5499 return wdev->address; 5500 } 5501 5502 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5503 { 5504 if (wdev->netdev) 5505 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 5506 return wdev->is_running; 5507 } 5508 5509 /** 5510 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 5511 * 5512 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 5513 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 5514 */ 5515 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5516 { 5517 BUG_ON(!wdev); 5518 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 5519 } 5520 5521 /** 5522 * DOC: Utility functions 5523 * 5524 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 5525 */ 5526 5527 /** 5528 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 5529 * 5530 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 5531 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 5532 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 5533 */ 5534 static inline bool 5535 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 5536 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 5537 { 5538 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 5539 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 5540 } 5541 5542 /** 5543 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 5544 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 5545 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 5546 */ 5547 static inline u32 5548 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5549 { 5550 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 5551 } 5552 5553 /** 5554 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 5555 * 5556 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 5557 * @chan: channel 5558 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 5559 */ 5560 enum nl80211_chan_width 5561 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 5562 5563 /** 5564 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 5565 * @chan: channel number 5566 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5567 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5568 */ 5569 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 5570 5571 /** 5572 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 5573 * @chan: channel number 5574 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5575 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5576 */ 5577 static inline int 5578 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 5579 { 5580 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 5581 } 5582 5583 /** 5584 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5585 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 5586 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5587 */ 5588 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 5589 5590 /** 5591 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5592 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 5593 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5594 */ 5595 static inline int 5596 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 5597 { 5598 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5599 } 5600 5601 /** 5602 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 5603 * frequency 5604 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5605 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 5606 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5607 */ 5608 struct ieee80211_channel * 5609 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 5610 5611 /** 5612 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 5613 * 5614 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5615 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 5616 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5617 */ 5618 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 5619 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 5620 { 5621 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5622 } 5623 5624 /** 5625 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 5626 * @chan: control channel to check 5627 * 5628 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 5629 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 5630 */ 5631 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5632 { 5633 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 5634 return false; 5635 5636 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 5637 } 5638 5639 /** 5640 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 5641 * 5642 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5643 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 5644 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 5645 * 5646 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 5647 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 5648 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 5649 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 5650 */ 5651 const struct ieee80211_rate * 5652 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5653 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 5654 5655 /** 5656 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 5657 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5658 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 5659 * 5660 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 5661 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 5662 */ 5663 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5664 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); 5665 5666 /* 5667 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 5668 * 5669 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 5670 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 5671 */ 5672 5673 struct radiotap_align_size { 5674 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 5675 }; 5676 5677 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 5678 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 5679 int n_bits; 5680 uint32_t oui; 5681 uint8_t subns; 5682 }; 5683 5684 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 5685 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 5686 int n_ns; 5687 }; 5688 5689 /** 5690 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 5691 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 5692 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 5693 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 5694 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 5695 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 5696 * the beginning of the actual data portion 5697 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 5698 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 5699 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 5700 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 5701 * radiotap namespace or not 5702 * 5703 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 5704 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 5705 * @_arg_index: next argument index 5706 * @_arg: next argument pointer 5707 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 5708 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 5709 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 5710 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 5711 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 5712 * next bitmap word 5713 * 5714 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 5715 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 5716 */ 5717 5718 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 5719 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 5720 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 5721 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 5722 5723 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 5724 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 5725 5726 unsigned char *this_arg; 5727 int this_arg_index; 5728 int this_arg_size; 5729 5730 int is_radiotap_ns; 5731 5732 int _max_length; 5733 int _arg_index; 5734 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 5735 int _reset_on_ext; 5736 }; 5737 5738 int 5739 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 5740 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 5741 int max_length, 5742 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 5743 5744 int 5745 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 5746 5747 5748 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 5749 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 5750 5751 /** 5752 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 5753 * 5754 * @skb: the frame 5755 * 5756 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 5757 * returns the 802.11 header length. 5758 * 5759 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 5760 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 5761 * 802.11 header. 5762 */ 5763 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 5764 5765 /** 5766 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 5767 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 5768 * Return: The header length in bytes. 5769 */ 5770 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 5771 5772 /** 5773 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 5774 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 5775 * (first byte) will be accessed 5776 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 5777 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 5778 */ 5779 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 5780 5781 /** 5782 * DOC: Data path helpers 5783 * 5784 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 5785 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 5786 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 5787 */ 5788 5789 /** 5790 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5791 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5792 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 5793 * of it being pushed into the SKB 5794 * @addr: the device MAC address 5795 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5796 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 5797 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5798 */ 5799 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 5800 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5801 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 5802 5803 /** 5804 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5805 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5806 * @addr: the device MAC address 5807 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5808 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5809 */ 5810 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 5811 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 5812 { 5813 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 5814 } 5815 5816 /** 5817 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 5818 * 5819 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 5820 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 5821 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 5822 * 5823 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 5824 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 5825 * initialized by the caller. 5826 * @addr: The device MAC address. 5827 * @iftype: The device interface type. 5828 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 5829 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5830 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5831 */ 5832 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 5833 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5834 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 5835 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa); 5836 5837 /** 5838 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 5839 * @skb: the data frame 5840 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 5841 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 5842 */ 5843 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 5844 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 5845 5846 /** 5847 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 5848 * 5849 * @eid: element ID 5850 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5851 * @len: length of data 5852 * @match: byte array to match 5853 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5854 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 5855 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 5856 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 5857 * the data portion instead. 5858 * 5859 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5860 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5861 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5862 * requested element struct. 5863 * 5864 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5865 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5866 * byte array to match. 5867 */ 5868 const struct element * 5869 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5870 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5871 unsigned int match_offset); 5872 5873 /** 5874 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 5875 * 5876 * @eid: element ID 5877 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5878 * @len: length of data 5879 * @match: byte array to match 5880 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5881 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 5882 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 5883 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 5884 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 5885 * the second byte is the IE length. 5886 * 5887 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5888 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5889 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 5890 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5891 * element ID. 5892 * 5893 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5894 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5895 * byte array to match. 5896 */ 5897 static inline const u8 * 5898 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5899 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5900 unsigned int match_offset) 5901 { 5902 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 5903 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 5904 */ 5905 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 5906 (!match_len && match_offset))) 5907 return NULL; 5908 5909 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 5910 match, match_len, 5911 match_offset ? 5912 match_offset - 2 : 0); 5913 } 5914 5915 /** 5916 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 5917 * 5918 * @eid: element ID 5919 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5920 * @len: length of data 5921 * 5922 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5923 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5924 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5925 * requested element struct. 5926 * 5927 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5928 * having to fit into the given data. 5929 */ 5930 static inline const struct element * 5931 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5932 { 5933 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5934 } 5935 5936 /** 5937 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 5938 * 5939 * @eid: element ID 5940 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5941 * @len: length of data 5942 * 5943 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5944 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5945 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5946 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5947 * 5948 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5949 * having to fit into the given data. 5950 */ 5951 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5952 { 5953 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5954 } 5955 5956 /** 5957 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 5958 * 5959 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5960 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5961 * @len: length of data 5962 * 5963 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if 5964 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5965 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5966 * requested element struct. 5967 * 5968 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5969 * having to fit into the given data. 5970 */ 5971 static inline const struct element * 5972 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5973 { 5974 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5975 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 5976 } 5977 5978 /** 5979 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 5980 * 5981 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5982 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5983 * @len: length of data 5984 * 5985 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 5986 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5987 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5988 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5989 * 5990 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5991 * having to fit into the given data. 5992 */ 5993 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5994 { 5995 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5996 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 5997 } 5998 5999 /** 6000 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 6001 * 6002 * @oui: vendor OUI 6003 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6004 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6005 * @len: length of data 6006 * 6007 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6008 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 6009 * return the element structure for the requested element. 6010 * 6011 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6012 * the given data. 6013 */ 6014 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6015 const u8 *ies, 6016 unsigned int len); 6017 6018 /** 6019 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 6020 * 6021 * @oui: vendor OUI 6022 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6023 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6024 * @len: length of data 6025 * 6026 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6027 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 6028 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6029 * element ID. 6030 * 6031 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6032 * the given data. 6033 */ 6034 static inline const u8 * 6035 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6036 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 6037 { 6038 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 6039 } 6040 6041 /** 6042 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 6043 * 6044 * @dev: network device 6045 * @addr: STA MAC address 6046 * 6047 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 6048 * devices upon STA association. 6049 */ 6050 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6051 6052 /** 6053 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 6054 * 6055 * TODO 6056 */ 6057 6058 /** 6059 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 6060 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 6061 * conflicts) 6062 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 6063 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 6064 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 6065 * alpha2. 6066 * 6067 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 6068 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 6069 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 6070 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 6071 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 6072 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 6073 * 6074 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 6075 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 6076 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 6077 * 6078 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6079 * an -ENOMEM. 6080 * 6081 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 6082 */ 6083 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 6084 6085 /** 6086 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 6087 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6088 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy 6089 * 6090 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 6091 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 6092 * information. 6093 * 6094 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6095 */ 6096 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6097 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6098 6099 /** 6100 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers 6101 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6102 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6103 * 6104 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and 6105 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details 6106 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 6107 * 6108 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6109 */ 6110 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6111 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6112 6113 /** 6114 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 6115 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6116 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 6117 * 6118 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 6119 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 6120 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 6121 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 6122 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 6123 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 6124 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 6125 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 6126 * that called this helper. 6127 */ 6128 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6129 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 6130 6131 /** 6132 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 6133 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 6134 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 6135 * 6136 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 6137 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 6138 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 6139 * and processed already. 6140 * 6141 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 6142 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 6143 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 6144 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 6145 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 6146 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 6147 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 6148 */ 6149 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6150 u32 center_freq); 6151 6152 /** 6153 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 6154 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 6155 * 6156 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 6157 * proper string representation. 6158 */ 6159 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 6160 6161 /** 6162 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 6163 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 6164 * 6165 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 6166 */ 6167 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6168 6169 /** 6170 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 6171 * 6172 */ 6173 6174 /** 6175 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6176 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6177 * 6178 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6179 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. 6180 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6181 * 6182 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6183 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6184 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6185 * 6186 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6187 * an -ENODATA. 6188 * 6189 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6190 */ 6191 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6192 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6193 6194 /* 6195 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6196 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6197 */ 6198 6199 /** 6200 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6201 * 6202 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6203 * @info: information about the completed scan 6204 */ 6205 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6206 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6207 6208 /** 6209 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6210 * 6211 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6212 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6213 */ 6214 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6215 6216 /** 6217 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6218 * 6219 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6220 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6221 * 6222 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6223 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6224 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6225 */ 6226 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6227 6228 /** 6229 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6230 * 6231 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6232 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6233 * 6234 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6235 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6236 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6237 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. 6238 */ 6239 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6240 6241 /** 6242 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 6243 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6244 * @data: the BSS metadata 6245 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 6246 * @len: length of the management frame 6247 * @gfp: context flags 6248 * 6249 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6250 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6251 * 6252 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6253 * Or %NULL on error. 6254 */ 6255 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6256 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6257 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6258 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6259 gfp_t gfp); 6260 6261 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6262 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6263 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6264 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6265 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6266 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6267 { 6268 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6269 .chan = rx_channel, 6270 .scan_width = scan_width, 6271 .signal = signal, 6272 }; 6273 6274 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6275 } 6276 6277 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6278 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6279 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6280 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6281 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6282 { 6283 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6284 .chan = rx_channel, 6285 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6286 .signal = signal, 6287 }; 6288 6289 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6290 } 6291 6292 /** 6293 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 6294 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 6295 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 6296 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 6297 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 6298 */ 6299 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 6300 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 6301 { 6302 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 6303 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 6304 u64 new_bssid_u64; 6305 6306 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 6307 6308 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 6309 6310 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 6311 } 6312 6313 /** 6314 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 6315 * @element: element to check 6316 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 6317 */ 6318 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 6319 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 6320 6321 /** 6322 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 6323 * @ie: ies 6324 * @ielen: length of IEs 6325 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 6326 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 6327 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 6328 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 6329 */ 6330 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6331 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 6332 const struct element *sub_elem, 6333 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 6334 6335 /** 6336 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 6337 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 6338 * from a beacon or probe response 6339 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 6340 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 6341 */ 6342 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 6343 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 6344 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 6345 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 6346 }; 6347 6348 /** 6349 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 6350 * 6351 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6352 * @data: the BSS metadata 6353 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 6354 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 6355 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 6356 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 6357 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 6358 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 6359 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 6360 * @gfp: context flags 6361 * 6362 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6363 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6364 * 6365 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6366 * Or %NULL on error. 6367 */ 6368 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6369 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6370 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6371 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6372 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6373 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6374 gfp_t gfp); 6375 6376 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6377 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6378 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6379 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6380 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6381 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6382 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6383 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6384 { 6385 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6386 .chan = rx_channel, 6387 .scan_width = scan_width, 6388 .signal = signal, 6389 }; 6390 6391 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6392 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6393 gfp); 6394 } 6395 6396 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6397 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6398 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6399 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6400 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6401 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6402 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6403 { 6404 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6405 .chan = rx_channel, 6406 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6407 .signal = signal, 6408 }; 6409 6410 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6411 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6412 gfp); 6413 } 6414 6415 /** 6416 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 6417 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6418 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 6419 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 6420 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 6421 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 6422 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 6423 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 6424 */ 6425 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6426 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6427 const u8 *bssid, 6428 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 6429 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 6430 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 6431 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 6432 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6433 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6434 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 6435 { 6436 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 6437 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 6438 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 6439 } 6440 6441 /** 6442 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 6443 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6444 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 6445 * 6446 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6447 */ 6448 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6449 6450 /** 6451 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 6452 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6453 * @bss: the BSS struct 6454 * 6455 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6456 */ 6457 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6458 6459 /** 6460 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 6461 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6462 * @bss: the bss to remove 6463 * 6464 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 6465 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 6466 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 6467 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 6468 */ 6469 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6470 6471 /** 6472 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 6473 * 6474 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 6475 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 6476 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 6477 * 6478 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6479 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 6480 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 6481 * @iter: the iterator function to call 6482 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 6483 */ 6484 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6485 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6486 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6487 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6488 void *data), 6489 void *iter_data); 6490 6491 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width 6492 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 6493 { 6494 switch (chandef->width) { 6495 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 6496 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; 6497 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 6498 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; 6499 default: 6500 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6501 } 6502 } 6503 6504 /** 6505 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 6506 * @dev: network device 6507 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 6508 * @len: length of the frame data 6509 * 6510 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 6511 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 6512 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 6513 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6514 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6515 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6516 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 6517 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 6518 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 6519 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 6520 * 6521 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6522 */ 6523 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6524 6525 /** 6526 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 6527 * @dev: network device 6528 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 6529 * 6530 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 6531 * mutex. 6532 */ 6533 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6534 6535 /** 6536 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 6537 * @dev: network device 6538 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 6539 * moves to cfg80211 in this call 6540 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 6541 * @len: length of the frame data 6542 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 6543 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 6544 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 6545 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 6546 * 6547 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6548 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6549 * 6550 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6551 */ 6552 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 6553 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6554 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6555 int uapsd_queues, 6556 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len); 6557 6558 /** 6559 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association 6560 * @dev: network device 6561 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out. 6562 * 6563 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6564 */ 6565 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6566 6567 /** 6568 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt 6569 * @dev: network device 6570 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned. 6571 * 6572 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX, 6573 * an association attempt was abandoned. 6574 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6575 */ 6576 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6577 6578 /** 6579 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 6580 * @dev: network device 6581 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 6582 * @len: length of the frame data 6583 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) 6584 * 6585 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 6586 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 6587 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 6588 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 6589 */ 6590 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6591 bool reconnect); 6592 6593 /** 6594 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 6595 * @dev: network device 6596 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 6597 * @len: length of the frame data 6598 * 6599 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 6600 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 6601 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 6602 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 6603 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 6604 * 6605 * This function may sleep. 6606 */ 6607 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 6608 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6609 6610 /** 6611 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 6612 * @dev: network device 6613 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 6614 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 6615 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 6616 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 6617 * @gfp: allocation flags 6618 * 6619 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 6620 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 6621 * primitive. 6622 */ 6623 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 6624 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 6625 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 6626 6627 /** 6628 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 6629 * 6630 * @dev: network device 6631 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 6632 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 6633 * @gfp: allocation flags 6634 * 6635 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 6636 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 6637 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 6638 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 6639 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 6640 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 6641 */ 6642 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6643 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 6644 6645 /** 6646 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 6647 * candidate 6648 * 6649 * @dev: network device 6650 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 6651 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 6652 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 6653 * @gfp: allocation flags 6654 * 6655 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 6656 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 6657 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 6658 */ 6659 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 6660 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 6661 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 6662 6663 /** 6664 * DOC: RFkill integration 6665 * 6666 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 6667 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 6668 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 6669 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 6670 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 6671 * 6672 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 6673 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 6674 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 6675 */ 6676 6677 /** 6678 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 6679 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6680 * @blocked: block status 6681 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons 6682 */ 6683 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, 6684 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); 6685 6686 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) 6687 { 6688 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, 6689 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); 6690 } 6691 6692 /** 6693 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 6694 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6695 */ 6696 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6697 6698 /** 6699 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 6700 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6701 */ 6702 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) 6703 { 6704 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); 6705 } 6706 6707 /** 6708 * DOC: Vendor commands 6709 * 6710 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 6711 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 6712 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 6713 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 6714 * the configuration mechanism. 6715 * 6716 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 6717 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 6718 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 6719 * 6720 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 6721 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 6722 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 6723 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 6724 * managers etc. need. 6725 */ 6726 6727 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6728 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6729 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6730 int approxlen); 6731 6732 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6733 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6734 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6735 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6736 unsigned int portid, 6737 int vendor_event_idx, 6738 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 6739 6740 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 6741 6742 /** 6743 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 6744 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6745 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6746 * be put into the skb 6747 * 6748 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6749 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6750 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 6751 * 6752 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 6753 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6754 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6755 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6756 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6757 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 6758 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 6759 * 6760 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 6761 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 6762 * 6763 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6764 */ 6765 static inline struct sk_buff * 6766 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6767 { 6768 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6769 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 6770 } 6771 6772 /** 6773 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 6774 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6775 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 6776 * 6777 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6778 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 6779 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 6780 * skb regardless of the return value. 6781 * 6782 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6783 */ 6784 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 6785 6786 /** 6787 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID 6788 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6789 * 6790 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 6791 * Valid to call only there. 6792 */ 6793 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6794 6795 /** 6796 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 6797 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6798 * @wdev: the wireless device 6799 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6800 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6801 * be put into the skb 6802 * @gfp: allocation flags 6803 * 6804 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6805 * vendor-specific multicast group. 6806 * 6807 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6808 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6809 * attribute. 6810 * 6811 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6812 * skb to send the event. 6813 * 6814 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6815 */ 6816 static inline struct sk_buff * 6817 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6818 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6819 { 6820 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6821 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6822 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6823 } 6824 6825 /** 6826 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 6827 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6828 * @wdev: the wireless device 6829 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6830 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 6831 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6832 * be put into the skb 6833 * @gfp: allocation flags 6834 * 6835 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 6836 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 6837 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 6838 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 6839 * 6840 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6841 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6842 * attribute. 6843 * 6844 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6845 * skb to send the event. 6846 * 6847 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6848 */ 6849 static inline struct sk_buff * 6850 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6851 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6852 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 6853 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6854 { 6855 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6856 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6857 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6858 } 6859 6860 /** 6861 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 6862 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 6863 * @gfp: allocation flags 6864 * 6865 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6866 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 6867 */ 6868 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6869 { 6870 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6871 } 6872 6873 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 6874 /** 6875 * DOC: Test mode 6876 * 6877 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 6878 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 6879 * factory programming. 6880 * 6881 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 6882 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 6883 */ 6884 6885 /** 6886 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 6887 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6888 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6889 * be put into the skb 6890 * 6891 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6892 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6893 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 6894 * 6895 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 6896 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6897 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6898 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6899 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6900 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 6901 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 6902 * 6903 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 6904 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 6905 * 6906 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6907 */ 6908 static inline struct sk_buff * 6909 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6910 { 6911 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6912 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 6913 } 6914 6915 /** 6916 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 6917 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6918 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 6919 * 6920 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6921 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 6922 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 6923 * regardless of the return value. 6924 * 6925 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6926 */ 6927 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 6928 { 6929 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 6930 } 6931 6932 /** 6933 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 6934 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6935 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6936 * be put into the skb 6937 * @gfp: allocation flags 6938 * 6939 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6940 * testmode multicast group. 6941 * 6942 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 6943 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 6944 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 6945 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 6946 * in any other way. 6947 * 6948 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 6949 * skb to send the event. 6950 * 6951 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6952 */ 6953 static inline struct sk_buff * 6954 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 6955 { 6956 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6957 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 6958 approxlen, gfp); 6959 } 6960 6961 /** 6962 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 6963 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6964 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 6965 * @gfp: allocation flags 6966 * 6967 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6968 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 6969 * consumes it. 6970 */ 6971 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6972 { 6973 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6974 } 6975 6976 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 6977 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 6978 #else 6979 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 6980 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 6981 #endif 6982 6983 /** 6984 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 6985 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 6986 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 6987 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 6988 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 6989 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 6990 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 6991 * status for a FILS connection. 6992 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6993 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 6994 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 6995 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6996 */ 6997 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 6998 const u8 *kek; 6999 size_t kek_len; 7000 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 7001 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 7002 const u8 *pmk; 7003 size_t pmk_len; 7004 const u8 *pmkid; 7005 }; 7006 7007 /** 7008 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 7009 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7010 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7011 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7012 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7013 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7014 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7015 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7016 * case. 7017 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL) 7018 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 7019 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 7020 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 7021 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 7022 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 7023 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 7024 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 7025 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 7026 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7027 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 7028 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 7029 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7030 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7031 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7032 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7033 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7034 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7035 */ 7036 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 7037 int status; 7038 const u8 *bssid; 7039 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7040 const u8 *req_ie; 7041 size_t req_ie_len; 7042 const u8 *resp_ie; 7043 size_t resp_ie_len; 7044 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7045 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 7046 }; 7047 7048 /** 7049 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7050 * 7051 * @dev: network device 7052 * @params: connection response parameters 7053 * @gfp: allocation flags 7054 * 7055 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7056 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7057 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 7058 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 7059 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 7060 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7061 */ 7062 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 7063 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 7064 gfp_t gfp); 7065 7066 /** 7067 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7068 * 7069 * @dev: network device 7070 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7071 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 7072 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 7073 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 7074 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 7075 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 7076 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 7077 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7078 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7079 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7080 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7081 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7082 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7083 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7084 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7085 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7086 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7087 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7088 * case. 7089 * @gfp: allocation flags 7090 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7091 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7092 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7093 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7094 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7095 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7096 * 7097 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7098 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7099 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 7100 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 7101 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7102 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7103 */ 7104 static inline void 7105 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7106 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 7107 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 7108 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 7109 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7110 { 7111 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 7112 7113 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 7114 params.status = status; 7115 params.bssid = bssid; 7116 params.bss = bss; 7117 params.req_ie = req_ie; 7118 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 7119 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 7120 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 7121 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 7122 7123 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 7124 } 7125 7126 /** 7127 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7128 * 7129 * @dev: network device 7130 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7131 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7132 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7133 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7134 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7135 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7136 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7137 * the real status code for failures. 7138 * @gfp: allocation flags 7139 * 7140 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7141 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7142 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 7143 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7144 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7145 */ 7146 static inline void 7147 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7148 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 7149 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 7150 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 7151 { 7152 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 7153 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 7154 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 7155 } 7156 7157 /** 7158 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 7159 * 7160 * @dev: network device 7161 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7162 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7163 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7164 * @gfp: allocation flags 7165 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 7166 * 7167 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 7168 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 7169 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 7170 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 7171 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 7172 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7173 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7174 */ 7175 static inline void 7176 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7177 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 7178 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7179 { 7180 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 7181 gfp, timeout_reason); 7182 } 7183 7184 /** 7185 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 7186 * 7187 * @channel: the channel of the new AP 7188 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set) 7189 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set) 7190 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7191 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7192 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7193 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7194 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7195 */ 7196 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7197 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 7198 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7199 const u8 *bssid; 7200 const u8 *req_ie; 7201 size_t req_ie_len; 7202 const u8 *resp_ie; 7203 size_t resp_ie_len; 7204 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7205 }; 7206 7207 /** 7208 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 7209 * 7210 * @dev: network device 7211 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 7212 * @gfp: allocation flags 7213 * 7214 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 7215 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 7216 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 7217 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 7218 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 7219 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 7220 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 7221 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 7222 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 7223 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 7224 */ 7225 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 7226 gfp_t gfp); 7227 7228 /** 7229 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 7230 * 7231 * @dev: network device 7232 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7233 * @gfp: allocation flags 7234 * 7235 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 7236 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 7237 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 7238 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 7239 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 7240 * indicate the 802.11 association. 7241 */ 7242 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7243 gfp_t gfp); 7244 7245 /** 7246 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 7247 * 7248 * @dev: network device 7249 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 7250 * @ie_len: length of IEs 7251 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 7252 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 7253 * @gfp: allocation flags 7254 * 7255 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 7256 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 7257 */ 7258 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 7259 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 7260 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 7261 7262 /** 7263 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 7264 * @wdev: wireless device 7265 * @cookie: the request cookie 7266 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7267 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 7268 * channel 7269 * @gfp: allocation flags 7270 */ 7271 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7272 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7273 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 7274 7275 /** 7276 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 7277 * @wdev: wireless device 7278 * @cookie: the request cookie 7279 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7280 * @gfp: allocation flags 7281 */ 7282 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7283 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7284 gfp_t gfp); 7285 7286 /** 7287 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 7288 * @wdev: wireless device 7289 * @cookie: the requested cookie 7290 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 7291 * @gfp: allocation flags 7292 */ 7293 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7294 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 7295 7296 /** 7297 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 7298 * 7299 * @sinfo: the station information 7300 * @gfp: allocation flags 7301 */ 7302 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7303 7304 /** 7305 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 7306 * @sinfo: the station information 7307 * 7308 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 7309 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 7310 * the stack.) 7311 */ 7312 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 7313 { 7314 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 7315 } 7316 7317 /** 7318 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 7319 * 7320 * @dev: the netdev 7321 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7322 * @sinfo: the station information 7323 * @gfp: allocation flags 7324 */ 7325 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7326 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7327 7328 /** 7329 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7330 * @dev: the netdev 7331 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7332 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 7333 * @gfp: allocation flags 7334 */ 7335 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7336 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7337 7338 /** 7339 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7340 * 7341 * @dev: the netdev 7342 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7343 * @gfp: allocation flags 7344 */ 7345 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 7346 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 7347 { 7348 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 7349 } 7350 7351 /** 7352 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 7353 * 7354 * @dev: the netdev 7355 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7356 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 7357 * @gfp: allocation flags 7358 * 7359 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 7360 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 7361 * for some reasons, this function is called. 7362 * 7363 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 7364 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 7365 */ 7366 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7367 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 7368 gfp_t gfp); 7369 7370 /** 7371 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7372 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7373 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 7374 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7375 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7376 * @len: length of the frame data 7377 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7378 * 7379 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7380 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7381 * 7382 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7383 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7384 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7385 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7386 */ 7387 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm, 7388 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags); 7389 7390 /** 7391 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7392 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7393 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 7394 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7395 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7396 * @len: length of the frame data 7397 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7398 * 7399 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7400 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7401 * 7402 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7403 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7404 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7405 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7406 */ 7407 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 7408 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7409 u32 flags) 7410 { 7411 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len, 7412 flags); 7413 } 7414 7415 /** 7416 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 7417 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7418 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 7419 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7420 * @len: length of the frame data 7421 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7422 * @gfp: context flags 7423 * 7424 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 7425 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 7426 * transmission attempt. 7427 */ 7428 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7429 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp); 7430 7431 /** 7432 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 7433 * port frames 7434 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7435 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 7436 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 7437 * @len: length of the frame data 7438 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7439 * @gfp: context flags 7440 * 7441 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 7442 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 7443 * the transmission attempt. 7444 */ 7445 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7446 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 7447 gfp_t gfp); 7448 7449 /** 7450 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 7451 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7452 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 7453 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 7454 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 7455 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 7456 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 7457 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 7458 * 7459 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 7460 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 7461 * control port frames over nl80211. 7462 * 7463 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 7464 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 7465 * 7466 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 7467 */ 7468 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, 7469 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted); 7470 7471 /** 7472 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 7473 * @dev: network device 7474 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 7475 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 7476 * @gfp: context flags 7477 * 7478 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 7479 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 7480 */ 7481 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7482 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 7483 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 7484 7485 /** 7486 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 7487 * @dev: network device 7488 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7489 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 7490 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 7491 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 7492 * @gfp: context flags 7493 */ 7494 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7495 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 7496 7497 /** 7498 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 7499 * @dev: network device 7500 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7501 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 7502 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 7503 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 7504 * @gfp: context flags 7505 * 7506 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 7507 * given interval is exceeded. 7508 */ 7509 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7510 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 7511 7512 /** 7513 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 7514 * @dev: network device 7515 * @gfp: context flags 7516 * 7517 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 7518 */ 7519 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 7520 7521 /** 7522 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 7523 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7524 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7525 * @gfp: context flags 7526 * 7527 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 7528 */ 7529 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7530 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp); 7531 7532 /** 7533 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 7534 * @dev: network device 7535 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 7536 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 7537 * @gfp: context flags 7538 * 7539 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 7540 * frame. 7541 */ 7542 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 7543 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 7544 gfp_t gfp); 7545 7546 /** 7547 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 7548 * @netdev: network device 7549 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7550 * @event: type of event 7551 * @gfp: context flags 7552 * 7553 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 7554 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 7555 * also by full-MAC drivers. 7556 */ 7557 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7558 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7559 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 7560 7561 7562 /** 7563 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 7564 * @dev: network device 7565 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 7566 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 7567 * @gfp: allocation flags 7568 */ 7569 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7570 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 7571 7572 /** 7573 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 7574 * @dev: network device 7575 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 7576 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 7577 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 7578 * @gfp: allocation flags 7579 */ 7580 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 7581 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 7582 7583 /** 7584 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 7585 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7586 * @addr: the transmitter address 7587 * @gfp: context flags 7588 * 7589 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7590 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 7591 * sender. 7592 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7593 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7594 */ 7595 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7596 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7597 7598 /** 7599 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 7600 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7601 * @addr: the transmitter address 7602 * @gfp: context flags 7603 * 7604 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7605 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 7606 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 7607 * station to avoid event flooding. 7608 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7609 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7610 */ 7611 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7612 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7613 7614 /** 7615 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 7616 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 7617 * @addr: the address of the peer 7618 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 7619 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 7620 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 7621 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 7622 * @gfp: allocation flags 7623 */ 7624 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7625 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 7626 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 7627 7628 /** 7629 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 7630 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7631 * @frame: the frame 7632 * @len: length of the frame 7633 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 7634 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7635 * 7636 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7637 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7638 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7639 */ 7640 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 7641 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 7642 7643 /** 7644 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 7645 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7646 * @frame: the frame 7647 * @len: length of the frame 7648 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 7649 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7650 * 7651 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7652 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7653 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7654 */ 7655 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7656 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 7657 int freq, int sig_dbm) 7658 { 7659 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 7660 sig_dbm); 7661 } 7662 7663 /** 7664 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 7665 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7666 * @chandef: the channel definition 7667 * @iftype: interface type 7668 * 7669 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7670 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 7671 */ 7672 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7673 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7674 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7675 7676 /** 7677 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 7678 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7679 * @chandef: the channel definition 7680 * @iftype: interface type 7681 * 7682 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7683 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 7684 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 7685 * more permissive conditions. 7686 * 7687 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. 7688 */ 7689 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7690 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7691 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7692 7693 /* 7694 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 7695 * @dev: the device which switched channels 7696 * @chandef: the new channel definition 7697 * 7698 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable 7699 * driver context! 7700 */ 7701 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7702 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 7703 7704 /* 7705 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 7706 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 7707 * @chandef: the future channel definition 7708 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 7709 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP 7710 * 7711 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 7712 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 7713 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 7714 */ 7715 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7716 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7717 u8 count, bool quiet); 7718 7719 /** 7720 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 7721 * 7722 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 7723 * @band: band pointer to fill 7724 * 7725 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7726 */ 7727 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 7728 enum nl80211_band *band); 7729 7730 /** 7731 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 7732 * 7733 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7734 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 7735 * 7736 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7737 */ 7738 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7739 u8 *op_class); 7740 7741 /** 7742 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 7743 * 7744 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7745 * 7746 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 7747 */ 7748 static inline u32 7749 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 7750 { 7751 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 7752 } 7753 7754 /* 7755 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 7756 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 7757 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 7758 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 7759 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 7760 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 7761 * @gfp: allocation flags 7762 * 7763 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 7764 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 7765 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 7766 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 7767 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 7768 */ 7769 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7770 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7771 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7772 7773 /* 7774 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 7775 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 7776 * 7777 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 7778 */ 7779 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 7780 7781 /** 7782 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 7783 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 7784 * 7785 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary 7786 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device 7787 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called 7788 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device 7789 * is unbound from the driver. 7790 * 7791 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7792 */ 7793 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 7794 7795 /** 7796 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev 7797 * @dev: the netdev to register 7798 * 7799 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 7800 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is 7801 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable 7802 * instead as well. 7803 * 7804 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7805 */ 7806 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); 7807 7808 /** 7809 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev 7810 * @dev: the netdev to register 7811 * 7812 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 7813 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL 7814 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are 7815 * usable instead as well. 7816 * 7817 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7818 */ 7819 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) 7820 { 7821 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); 7822 } 7823 7824 /** 7825 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 7826 * @ies: FT IEs 7827 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 7828 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 7829 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 7830 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 7831 */ 7832 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 7833 const u8 *ies; 7834 size_t ies_len; 7835 const u8 *target_ap; 7836 const u8 *ric_ies; 7837 size_t ric_ies_len; 7838 }; 7839 7840 /** 7841 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 7842 * @netdev: network device 7843 * @ft_event: IE information 7844 */ 7845 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7846 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 7847 7848 /** 7849 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 7850 * @ies: the input IE buffer 7851 * @len: the input length 7852 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 7853 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 7854 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 7855 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 7856 * 7857 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 7858 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 7859 * 7860 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 7861 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 7862 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 7863 */ 7864 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 7865 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 7866 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 7867 7868 /** 7869 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 7870 * @ies: the IE buffer 7871 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7872 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7873 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7874 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7875 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7876 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 7877 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 7878 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7879 * 7880 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7881 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7882 * split. 7883 * 7884 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7885 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7886 * 7887 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7888 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7889 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7890 * 7891 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7892 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7893 * of the buffer should be used. 7894 */ 7895 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7896 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 7897 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 7898 size_t offset); 7899 7900 /** 7901 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 7902 * @ies: the IE buffer 7903 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7904 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7905 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7906 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7907 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7908 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7909 * 7910 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7911 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7912 * split. 7913 * 7914 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7915 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7916 * 7917 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7918 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7919 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7920 * 7921 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7922 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7923 * of the buffer should be used. 7924 */ 7925 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7926 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 7927 { 7928 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 7929 } 7930 7931 /** 7932 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 7933 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 7934 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 7935 * @gfp: allocation flags 7936 * 7937 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 7938 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 7939 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 7940 * else caused the wakeup. 7941 */ 7942 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7943 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7944 gfp_t gfp); 7945 7946 /** 7947 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 7948 * 7949 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 7950 * @gfp: allocation flags 7951 * 7952 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 7953 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 7954 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 7955 */ 7956 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 7957 7958 /** 7959 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 7960 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7961 * 7962 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 7963 */ 7964 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7965 7966 /** 7967 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 7968 * 7969 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7970 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7971 * 7972 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 7973 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 7974 * the interface combinations. 7975 */ 7976 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7977 struct iface_combination_params *params); 7978 7979 /** 7980 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 7981 * 7982 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7983 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7984 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 7985 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 7986 * 7987 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 7988 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 7989 * purposes. 7990 */ 7991 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7992 struct iface_combination_params *params, 7993 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 7994 void *data), 7995 void *data); 7996 7997 /* 7998 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 7999 * 8000 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8001 * @wdev: wireless device 8002 * @gfp: context flags 8003 * 8004 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 8005 * disconnected. 8006 * 8007 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 8008 */ 8009 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8010 gfp_t gfp); 8011 8012 /** 8013 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 8014 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 8015 * 8016 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 8017 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 8018 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 8019 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 8020 * 8021 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 8022 * the driver while the function is running. 8023 */ 8024 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8025 8026 /** 8027 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 8028 * 8029 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8030 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8031 * 8032 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8033 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8034 */ 8035 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8036 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8037 { 8038 u8 *ft_byte; 8039 8040 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8041 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 8042 } 8043 8044 /** 8045 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 8046 * 8047 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8048 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8049 * 8050 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8051 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8052 */ 8053 static inline bool 8054 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8055 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8056 { 8057 u8 ft_byte; 8058 8059 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8060 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 8061 } 8062 8063 /** 8064 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 8065 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 8066 * 8067 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 8068 */ 8069 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 8070 8071 /** 8072 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 8073 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 8074 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 8075 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 8076 * result. 8077 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 8078 * @inst_id: the local instance id 8079 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 8080 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 8081 * @info_len: the length of the &info 8082 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 8083 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 8084 */ 8085 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 8086 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 8087 u8 inst_id; 8088 u8 peer_inst_id; 8089 const u8 *addr; 8090 u8 info_len; 8091 const u8 *info; 8092 u64 cookie; 8093 }; 8094 8095 /** 8096 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 8097 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 8098 * @match: match notification parameters 8099 * @gfp: allocation flags 8100 * 8101 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 8102 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 8103 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 8104 */ 8105 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8106 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 8107 8108 /** 8109 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 8110 * 8111 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 8112 * @inst_id: the local instance id 8113 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 8114 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 8115 * @gfp: allocation flags 8116 * 8117 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 8118 */ 8119 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8120 u8 inst_id, 8121 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 8122 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 8123 8124 /* ethtool helper */ 8125 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 8126 8127 /** 8128 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 8129 * @netdev: network device 8130 * @params: External authentication parameters 8131 * @gfp: allocation flags 8132 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 8133 */ 8134 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 8135 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 8136 gfp_t gfp); 8137 8138 /** 8139 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 8140 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 8141 * @req: the original measurement request 8142 * @result: the result data 8143 * @gfp: allocation flags 8144 */ 8145 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8146 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 8147 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 8148 gfp_t gfp); 8149 8150 /** 8151 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 8152 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 8153 * @req: the original measurement request 8154 * @gfp: allocation flags 8155 * 8156 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 8157 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 8158 */ 8159 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8160 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 8161 gfp_t gfp); 8162 8163 /** 8164 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 8165 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8166 * @iftype: interface type 8167 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 8168 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 8169 * 8170 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 8171 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 8172 * check_swif is '1'. 8173 */ 8174 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 8175 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 8176 8177 8178 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 8179 8180 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 8181 8182 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 8183 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8184 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8185 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8186 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8187 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8188 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8189 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8190 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8191 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8192 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8193 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8194 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8195 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8196 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8197 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8198 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8199 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8200 8201 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8202 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8203 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8204 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8205 8206 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8207 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 8208 8209 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8210 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8211 8212 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 8213 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 8214 #else 8215 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8216 ({ \ 8217 if (0) \ 8218 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 8219 0; \ 8220 }) 8221 #endif 8222 8223 /* 8224 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 8225 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 8226 * file/line information and a backtrace. 8227 */ 8228 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8229 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 8230 8231 /** 8232 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 8233 * @netdev: network device 8234 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 8235 * @gfp: allocation flags 8236 */ 8237 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8238 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 8239 gfp_t gfp); 8240 8241 /** 8242 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 8243 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8244 */ 8245 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8246 8247 /** 8248 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event 8249 * @dev: network device 8250 * @gfp: allocation flags 8251 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify 8252 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 8253 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 8254 */ 8255 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp, 8256 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count, 8257 u64 color_bitmap); 8258 8259 /** 8260 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision 8261 * @dev: network device 8262 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 8263 */ 8264 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8265 u64 color_bitmap) 8266 { 8267 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL, 8268 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 8269 0, color_bitmap); 8270 } 8271 8272 /** 8273 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start 8274 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 8275 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 8276 * 8277 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started. 8278 */ 8279 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8280 u8 count) 8281 { 8282 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL, 8283 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 8284 count, 0); 8285 } 8286 8287 /** 8288 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort 8289 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 8290 * 8291 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted. 8292 */ 8293 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev) 8294 { 8295 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL, 8296 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 8297 0, 0); 8298 } 8299 8300 /** 8301 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion 8302 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched 8303 * 8304 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed. 8305 */ 8306 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev) 8307 { 8308 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL, 8309 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 8310 0, 0); 8311 } 8312 8313 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 8314